* config/tc-alpha.c (alpha_align): Check, don't assert, that
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
CommitLineData
c906108c
SS
1\input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2@c Copyright 1988-1999
3@c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4@c
5@c %**start of header
6@c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
7@c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
8@setfilename gdb.info
9@c
10@include gdb-cfg.texi
11@c
c906108c 12@settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
13@setchapternewpage odd
14@c %**end of header
15
16@iftex
17@c @smallbook
18@c @cropmarks
19@end iftex
20
21@finalout
22@syncodeindex ky cp
23
24@c readline appendices use @vindex
25@syncodeindex vr cp
26
27@c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
28@set EDITION Seventh
29
30@c !!set GDB manual's revision date
31@set DATE February 1999
32
33@c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO-2 macros and info-makers to format properly.
34
35@ifinfo
36@c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
37@c manuals to an info tree. zoo@cygnus.com is developing this facility.
38@format
39START-INFO-DIR-ENTRY
40* Gdb: (gdb). The @sc{gnu} debugger.
41END-INFO-DIR-ENTRY
42@end format
43@end ifinfo
44@c
45@c
46@ifinfo
47This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
48
49
50This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE},
51of @cite{Debugging with @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger}
52for @value{GDBN} Version @value{GDBVN}.
53
54Copyright (C) 1988-1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
55
56Permission is granted to make and distribute verbatim copies of
57this manual provided the copyright notice and this permission notice
58are preserved on all copies.
59
60@ignore
61Permission is granted to process this file through TeX and print the
62results, provided the printed document carries copying permission
63notice identical to this one except for the removal of this paragraph
64(this paragraph not being relevant to the printed manual).
65
66@end ignore
67Permission is granted to copy and distribute modified versions of this
68manual under the conditions for verbatim copying, provided also that the
69entire resulting derived work is distributed under the terms of a
70permission notice identical to this one.
71
72Permission is granted to copy and distribute translations of this manual
73into another language, under the above conditions for modified versions.
74@end ifinfo
75
76@titlepage
77@title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
78@subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
c906108c 79@sp 1
c906108c
SS
80@subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
81@subtitle @value{DATE}
82@author Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch
c906108c 83@page
c906108c
SS
84@tex
85{\parskip=0pt
53a5351d 86\hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to bug-gdb\@gnu.org.)\par
c906108c
SS
87\hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
88\hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
89}
90@end tex
53a5351d
JM
91
92@c ISBN seems to be wrong...
c906108c
SS
93
94@vskip 0pt plus 1filll
95Copyright @copyright{} 1988-1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
96@sp 2
c906108c
SS
97Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
9859 Temple Place - Suite 330, @*
99Boston, MA 02111-1307 USA @*
100Printed copies are available for $20 each. @*
101ISBN 1-882114-11-6 @*
c906108c
SS
102
103Permission is granted to make and distribute verbatim copies of
104this manual provided the copyright notice and this permission notice
105are preserved on all copies.
106
107Permission is granted to copy and distribute modified versions of this
108manual under the conditions for verbatim copying, provided also that the
109entire resulting derived work is distributed under the terms of a
110permission notice identical to this one.
111
112Permission is granted to copy and distribute translations of this manual
113into another language, under the above conditions for modified versions.
114@end titlepage
115@page
116
117@ifinfo
53a5351d 118@node Top
c906108c
SS
119@top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
120
121This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
122
123This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE}, for @value{GDBN} Version
124@value{GDBVN}.
125
126Copyright (C) 1988-1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
127@menu
128* Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
c906108c 129* Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
c906108c
SS
130
131* Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
132* Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
133* Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
134* Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
135* Stack:: Examining the stack
136* Source:: Examining source files
137* Data:: Examining data
c906108c 138
7a292a7a 139* Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
c906108c
SS
140
141* Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
142* Altering:: Altering execution
143* GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
144* Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
104c1213 145* Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
c906108c
SS
146* Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
147* Sequences:: Canned sequences of commands
c906108c 148* Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
c906108c
SS
149
150* GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
c906108c 151* Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
c906108c
SS
152
153* Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
154* Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
155* Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
156* Index:: Index
c906108c
SS
157@end menu
158
159@end ifinfo
160
53a5351d 161@node Summary
c906108c
SS
162@unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
163
164The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
165going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
166program was doing at the moment it crashed.
167
168@value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
169these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
170
171@itemize @bullet
172@item
173Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
174
175@item
176Make your program stop on specified conditions.
177
178@item
179Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
180
181@item
182Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
183effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
184@end itemize
185
cce74817 186You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C++.
c906108c 187For more information, see @ref{Support,,Supported languages}.
c906108c
SS
188For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
189
cce74817
JM
190@cindex Chill
191@cindex Modula-2
c906108c 192Support for Modula-2 and Chill is partial. For information on Modula-2,
cce74817 193see @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}. For information on Chill, see @ref{Chill}.
c906108c 194
cce74817
JM
195@cindex Pascal
196Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
197nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
198entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
199syntax.
c906108c 200
c906108c
SS
201@cindex Fortran
202@value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
53a5351d 203it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
cce74817 204underscore.
c906108c 205
c906108c
SS
206@menu
207* Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
208* Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
209@end menu
210
53a5351d 211@node Free Software
c906108c
SS
212@unnumberedsec Free software
213
214@value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
215General Public License
216(GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
217program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
218freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
219the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
220Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
221Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
222
223Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
224you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
225from anyone else.
226
53a5351d 227@node Contributors
c906108c
SS
228@unnumberedsec Contributors to GDB
229
230Richard Stallman was the original author of GDB, and of many other
231@sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its development.
232This section attempts to credit major contributors. One of the virtues
233of free software is that everyone is free to contribute to it; with
234regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The file
235@file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
236blow-by-blow account.
237
238Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
239
240@quotation
241@emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
242or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
243omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
244@end quotation
245
246So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
247particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
248releases:
249Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
250Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
251Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
252Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
253Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
254John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
255Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
256and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
257
258Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
259Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
260
c906108c
SS
261Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C++ support in GDB,
262with significant additional contributions from Per Bothner. James
263Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C++ demangler. Early work on C++ was by Peter
264TerMaat (who also did much general update work leading to release 3.0).
c906108c
SS
265
266@value{GDBN} 4 uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
267object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
268Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
269
270David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
271the original support for encapsulated COFF.
272
273Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
274
275Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
276Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
277support.
278Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
279Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
280Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
281David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
282Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
283Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
284Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
285Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
286Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
287Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
288Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
289Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
290Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
291Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
292Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
293
294Andreas Schwab contributed M68K Linux support.
295
296Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
297libraries.
298
299Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
300about several machine instruction sets.
301
302Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
303remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
304contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
305and RDI targets, respectively.
306
307Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
308command-line editing and command history.
309
7a292a7a
SS
310Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
311Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
c906108c
SS
312
313Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
c906108c
SS
314He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C++ overloaded
315symbols.
c906108c
SS
316
317Hitachi America, Ltd. sponsored the support for H8/300, H8/500, and
318Super-H processors.
319
320NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
321
322Mitsubishi sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D processors.
323
324Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
325
326Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
327
328Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors
329
330Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
331watchpoints.
332
333Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
334
335Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
336
337Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
338nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout GDB.
339
340The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
341support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
342(narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC++
343compiler, and the terminal user interface: Ben Krepp, Richard Title,
344John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann, Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve
345Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase provided HP-specific
346information in this manual.
347
348Cygnus Solutions has sponsored GDB maintenance and much of its
349development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on GDB
2df3850c
JM
350fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
351Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
352Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
353Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
354Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
355addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
356JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
357Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
358Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
359Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
360Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
361Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
362Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
c906108c
SS
363
364
53a5351d 365@node Sample Session
c906108c
SS
366@chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
367
368You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
369However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
370debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
371
372@iftex
373In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
374to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
375@end iftex
376
377@c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
378@c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
379
380One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
381processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
382quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
383definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
384session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
385then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
386same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
387@code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
388procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
389
390@smallexample
391$ @b{cd gnu/m4}
392$ @b{./m4}
393@b{define(foo,0000)}
394
395@b{foo}
3960000
397@b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
398
399@b{bar}
4000000
401@b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
402
403@b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
404@b{baz}
405@b{C-d}
406m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
407@end smallexample
408
409@noindent
410Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
411
c906108c
SS
412@smallexample
413$ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
414@c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
415@c FIXME... format to come out better.
416@value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
417 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
418 the conditions.
419There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
420 for details.
421
422@value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
423(@value{GDBP})
424@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
425
426@noindent
427@value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
428rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
429We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
430that examples fit in this manual.
431
432@smallexample
433(@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
434@end smallexample
435
436@noindent
437We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
438Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
439@code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
440@code{break} command.
441
442@smallexample
443(@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
444Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
445@end smallexample
446
447@noindent
448Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
449control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
450subroutine, the program runs as usual:
451
452@smallexample
453(@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
454Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
455@b{define(foo,0000)}
456
457@b{foo}
4580000
459@end smallexample
460
461@noindent
462To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
463suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
464context where it stops.
465
466@smallexample
467@b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
468
469Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
470 at builtin.c:879
471879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
472@end smallexample
473
474@noindent
475Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
476the next line of the current function.
477
478@smallexample
479(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
480882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
481 : nil,
482@end smallexample
483
484@noindent
485@code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
486by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
487@code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
488subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
489
490@smallexample
491(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
492set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
493 at input.c:530
494530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
495@end smallexample
496
497@noindent
498The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
499suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
500shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
501command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
502in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
503stack frame for each active subroutine.
504
505@smallexample
506(@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
507#0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
508 at input.c:530
509#1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
510 at builtin.c:882
511#2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
512#3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
513 at macro.c:71
514#4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
515#5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
516@end smallexample
517
518@noindent
519We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
520times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
521falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
522
523@smallexample
524(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
5250x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
526(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
5270x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
528def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
529(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
530536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
531 : xstrdup(rq);
532(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
533538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
534@end smallexample
535
536@noindent
537The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
538@code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
539and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
540(@code{print}) to see their values.
541
542@smallexample
543(@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
544$1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
545(@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
546$2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
547@end smallexample
548
549@noindent
550@code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
551To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
552surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
553
554@smallexample
555(@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
556533 xfree(rquote);
557534
558535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
559 : xstrdup (lq);
560536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
561 : xstrdup (rq);
562537
563538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
564539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
565540 @}
566541
567542 void
568@end smallexample
569
570@noindent
571Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
572@code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
573
574@smallexample
575(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
576539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
577(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
578540 @}
579(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
580$3 = 9
581(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
582$4 = 7
583@end smallexample
584
585@noindent
586That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
587@code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
588@code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
589the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
590any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
591assignments.
592
593@smallexample
594(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
595$5 = 7
596(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
597$6 = 9
598@end smallexample
599
600@noindent
601Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
602@code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
603executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
604example that caused trouble initially:
605
606@smallexample
607(@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
608Continuing.
609
610@b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
611
612baz
6130000
614@end smallexample
615
616@noindent
617Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
618problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
619lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
620
621@smallexample
622@b{C-d}
623Program exited normally.
624@end smallexample
625
626@noindent
627The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
628indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
629session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
630
631@smallexample
632(@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
633@end smallexample
c906108c 634
53a5351d 635@node Invocation
c906108c
SS
636@chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
637
638This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
639The essentials are:
640@itemize @bullet
641@item
53a5351d 642type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
c906108c
SS
643@item
644type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{C-d} to exit.
645@end itemize
646
647@menu
648* Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
649* Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
650* Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
651@end menu
652
53a5351d 653@node Invoking GDB
c906108c
SS
654@section Invoking @value{GDBN}
655
c906108c
SS
656Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
657@value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
658
659You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
660to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
661
c906108c
SS
662The command-line options described here are designed
663to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
664options may effectively be unavailable.
c906108c
SS
665
666The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
667specifying an executable program:
668
669@example
670@value{GDBP} @var{program}
671@end example
672
c906108c
SS
673@noindent
674You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
675specified:
676
677@example
678@value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
679@end example
680
681You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
682to debug a running process:
683
684@example
685@value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
686@end example
687
688@noindent
689would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
690named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
691
c906108c 692Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
2df3850c
JM
693complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
694debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
695``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
696will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
c906108c
SS
697
698You can run @code{gdb} without printing the front material, which describes
699@value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
700
701@smallexample
702@value{GDBP} -silent
703@end smallexample
704
705@noindent
706You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
707options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
708
709@noindent
710Type
711
712@example
713@value{GDBP} -help
714@end example
715
716@noindent
717to display all available options and briefly describe their use
718(@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
719
720All options and command line arguments you give are processed
721in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
722@samp{-x} option is used.
723
724
725@menu
c906108c
SS
726* File Options:: Choosing files
727* Mode Options:: Choosing modes
728@end menu
729
c906108c
SS
730@node File Options
731@subsection Choosing files
732
2df3850c 733When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
c906108c
SS
734specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
735the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
736@samp{-c} options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the first argument
737that does not have an associated option flag as equivalent to the
738@samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the second argument
739that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as equivalent to
740the @samp{-c} option followed by that argument.)
7a292a7a
SS
741
742If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
743such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
744argument and ignore it.
c906108c
SS
745
746Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
747following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
748them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
749(If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
750than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
751
752@table @code
753@item -symbols @var{file}
754@itemx -s @var{file}
755Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
756
757@item -exec @var{file}
758@itemx -e @var{file}
7a292a7a
SS
759Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
760and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
c906108c
SS
761
762@item -se @var{file}
763Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
764file.
765
c906108c
SS
766@item -core @var{file}
767@itemx -c @var{file}
768Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
769
770@item -c @var{number}
771Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command
772(unless there is a file in core-dump format named @var{number}, in which
773case @samp{-c} specifies that file as a core dump to read).
c906108c
SS
774
775@item -command @var{file}
776@itemx -x @var{file}
777Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}. @xref{Command
778Files,, Command files}.
779
780@item -directory @var{directory}
781@itemx -d @var{directory}
782Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
783
c906108c
SS
784@item -m
785@itemx -mapped
786@emph{Warning: this option depends on operating system facilities that are not
787supported on all systems.}@*
788If memory-mapped files are available on your system through the @code{mmap}
789system call, you can use this option
790to have @value{GDBN} write the symbols from your
791program into a reusable file in the current directory. If the program you are debugging is
792called @file{/tmp/fred}, the mapped symbol file is @file{./fred.syms}.
793Future @value{GDBN} debugging sessions notice the presence of this file,
794and can quickly map in symbol information from it, rather than reading
795the symbol table from the executable program.
796
797The @file{.syms} file is specific to the host machine where @value{GDBN}
798is run. It holds an exact image of the internal @value{GDBN} symbol
799table. It cannot be shared across multiple host platforms.
c906108c 800
c906108c
SS
801@item -r
802@itemx -readnow
803Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
804the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
805This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
53a5351d 806
c906108c
SS
807@end table
808
2df3850c 809You typically combine the @code{-mapped} and @code{-readnow} options in
c906108c 810order to build a @file{.syms} file that contains complete symbol
2df3850c
JM
811information. (@xref{Files,,Commands to specify files}, for information
812on @file{.syms} files.) A simple @value{GDBN} invocation to do nothing
813but build a @file{.syms} file for future use is:
c906108c
SS
814
815@example
2df3850c 816gdb -batch -nx -mapped -readnow programname
c906108c 817@end example
c906108c 818
53a5351d 819@node Mode Options
c906108c
SS
820@subsection Choosing modes
821
822You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
823batch mode or quiet mode.
824
825@table @code
826@item -nx
827@itemx -n
2df3850c
JM
828Do not execute commands found in any initialization files (normally
829called @file{.gdbinit}, or @file{gdb.ini} on PCs). Normally,
830@value{GDBN} executes the commands in these files after all the command
831options and arguments have been processed. @xref{Command Files,,Command
832files}.
c906108c
SS
833
834@item -quiet
835@itemx -q
836``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
837messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
838
839@item -batch
840Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
841command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
842initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
843nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
844in the command files.
845
2df3850c
JM
846Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
847example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
848make this more useful, the message
c906108c
SS
849
850@example
851Program exited normally.
852@end example
853
854@noindent
2df3850c
JM
855(which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
856@value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
857mode.
858
859@item -nowindows
860@itemx -nw
861``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
862(GUI) built in, then this option tells GDB to only use the command-line
863interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
864
865@item -windows
866@itemx -w
867If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
868used if possible.
c906108c
SS
869
870@item -cd @var{directory}
871Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
872instead of the current directory.
873
c906108c
SS
874@item -fullname
875@itemx -f
7a292a7a
SS
876@sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
877subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
878number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
879displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
880recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
881the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
882and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
883@samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
884frame.
c906108c 885
2df3850c
JM
886@item -baud @var{bps}
887@itemx -b @var{bps}
c906108c
SS
888Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
889interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
c906108c
SS
890
891@item -tty @var{device}
892Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
893@c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
c906108c 894
53a5351d
JM
895@c resolve the situation of these eventually
896@c @item -tui
897@c Use a Terminal User Interface. For information, use your Web browser to
898@c read the file @file{TUI.html}, which is usually installed in the
899@c directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX systems. Do not use
900@c this option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs (see @pxref{Emacs, ,Using
901@c @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
902
903@c @item -xdb
904@c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
905@c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
906@c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
907@c systems.
908
c906108c
SS
909@end table
910
53a5351d 911@node Quitting GDB
c906108c
SS
912@section Quitting @value{GDBN}
913@cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
914@cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
915
916@table @code
917@kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
918@kindex q
919@item quit
920To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated @code{q}), or
921type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{C-d}). If you do not supply
922@var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally; otherwise it will
923terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the error code.
924@end table
925
926@cindex interrupt
927An interrupt (often @kbd{C-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
928terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
929returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
930character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
931until a time when it is safe.
932
c906108c
SS
933If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
934device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
935(@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running process}).
c906108c 936
53a5351d 937@node Shell Commands
c906108c
SS
938@section Shell commands
939
940If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
941debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
942just use the @code{shell} command.
943
944@table @code
945@kindex shell
946@cindex shell escape
947@item shell @var{command string}
948Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command string}.
c906108c 949If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
d4f3574e
SS
950shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
951(@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
c906108c
SS
952@end table
953
954The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
955You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
956@value{GDBN}:
957
958@table @code
959@kindex make
960@cindex calling make
961@item make @var{make-args}
962Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
963arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
964@end table
965
53a5351d 966@node Commands
c906108c
SS
967@chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
968
969You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
970name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
971@value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
972key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
973show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
974
975@menu
976* Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
977* Completion:: Command completion
978* Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
979@end menu
980
53a5351d 981@node Command Syntax
c906108c
SS
982@section Command syntax
983
984A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
985how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
986arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
987command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
988step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
989with no arguments. Some command names do not allow any arguments.
990
991@cindex abbreviation
992@value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
993unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
994documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
995abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
996equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
997names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
998arguments to the @code{help} command.
999
1000@cindex repeating commands
1001@kindex RET
1002A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1003repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1004will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1005repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1006repeat.
1007
1008The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1009@key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1010exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1011
1012@value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1013output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1014(@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen size}). Since it is easy to press one
1015@key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1016repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1017
1018@kindex #
1019@cindex comment
1020Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1021nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1022Files,,Command files}).
1023
53a5351d 1024@node Completion
c906108c
SS
1025@section Command completion
1026
1027@cindex completion
1028@cindex word completion
1029@value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1030only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1031are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1032commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1033
1034Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1035of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1036word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1037enter it). For example, if you type
1038
1039@c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1040@c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1041@c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1042@c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1043@example
1044(@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1045@end example
1046
1047@noindent
1048@value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1049the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1050
1051@example
1052(@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1053@end example
1054
1055@noindent
1056You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1057breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1058@samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1059were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1060might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1061to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1062
1063If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1064@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1065characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1066@value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1067example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1068begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1069just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1070function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1071example:
1072
1073@example
1074(@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1075@exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1076make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1077make_abs_section make_function_type
1078make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1079make_cleanup make_reference_type
1080make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1081(@value{GDBP}) b make_
1082@end example
1083
1084@noindent
1085After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1086partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1087command.
1088
1089If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1090can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
7a292a7a 1091means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
c906108c 1092key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
7a292a7a 1093one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
c906108c
SS
1094
1095@cindex quotes in commands
1096@cindex completion of quoted strings
1097Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
7a292a7a
SS
1098parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1099its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1100situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1101@value{GDBN} commands.
c906108c 1102
c906108c
SS
1103The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1104name of a C++ function. This is because C++ allows function overloading
1105(multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished by argument
1106type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you may need to
1107distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name} that takes an
1108@code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version that takes a
1109@code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the word-completion
1110facilities in this situation, type a single quote @code{'} at the
1111beginning of the function name. This alerts @value{GDBN} that it may need to
1112consider more information than usual when you press @key{TAB} or
1113@kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1114
1115@example
1116(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @key{M-?}
1117bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1118(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1119@end example
1120
1121In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1122quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1123completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1124place:
1125
1126@example
1127(@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1128@exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1129(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1130@end example
1131
1132@noindent
1133In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1134you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1135completion on an overloaded symbol.
1136
d4f3574e 1137For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C plus plus
c906108c
SS
1138expressions, ,C++ expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1139overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
d4f3574e 1140see @ref{Debugging C plus plus, ,@value{GDBN} features for C++}.
c906108c
SS
1141
1142
53a5351d 1143@node Help
c906108c
SS
1144@section Getting help
1145@cindex online documentation
1146@kindex help
1147
1148You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1149using the command @code{help}.
1150
1151@table @code
1152@kindex h
1153@item help
1154@itemx h
1155You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1156display a short list of named classes of commands:
1157
1158@smallexample
1159(@value{GDBP}) help
1160List of classes of commands:
1161
2df3850c 1162aliases -- Aliases of other commands
c906108c 1163breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
2df3850c 1164data -- Examining data
c906108c 1165files -- Specifying and examining files
2df3850c
JM
1166internals -- Maintenance commands
1167obscure -- Obscure features
1168running -- Running the program
1169stack -- Examining the stack
c906108c
SS
1170status -- Status inquiries
1171support -- Support facilities
2df3850c 1172tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without stopping the program
c906108c 1173user-defined -- User-defined commands
c906108c
SS
1174
1175Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1176commands in that class.
1177Type "help" followed by command name for full
1178documentation.
1179Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1180(@value{GDBP})
1181@end smallexample
1182
1183@item help @var{class}
1184Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1185list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1186help display for the class @code{status}:
1187
1188@smallexample
1189(@value{GDBP}) help status
1190Status inquiries.
1191
1192List of commands:
1193
1194@c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1195@c to fit in smallbook page size.
2df3850c
JM
1196info -- Generic command for showing things
1197 about the program being debugged
1198show -- Generic command for showing things
1199 about the debugger
c906108c
SS
1200
1201Type "help" followed by command name for full
1202documentation.
1203Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1204(@value{GDBP})
1205@end smallexample
1206
1207@item help @var{command}
1208With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1209short paragraph on how to use that command.
1210
1211@kindex complete
1212@item complete @var{args}
1213The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1214for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1215command you want completed. For example:
1216
1217@smallexample
1218complete i
1219@end smallexample
1220
1221@noindent results in:
1222
1223@smallexample
1224@group
2df3850c
JM
1225if
1226ignore
c906108c
SS
1227info
1228inspect
c906108c
SS
1229@end group
1230@end smallexample
1231
1232@noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1233@end table
1234
1235In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1236and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1237of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1238manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1239under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to
1240all the sub-commands. @xref{Index}.
1241
1242@c @group
1243@table @code
1244@kindex info
1245@kindex i
1246@item info
1247This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1248program. For example, you can list the arguments given to your program
1249with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1250registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1251You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1252@w{@code{help info}}.
1253
1254@kindex set
1255@item set
1256You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1257@code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1258@code{set prompt $}.
1259
1260@kindex show
1261@item show
1262In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1263@value{GDBN} itself.
1264You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1265related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1266system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1267which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1268
1269@kindex info set
1270To display all the settable parameters and their current
1271values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1272@code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1273@c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1274@c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1275@c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1276@end table
1277@c @end group
1278
1279Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1280exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1281
1282@table @code
1283@kindex show version
1284@cindex version number
1285@item show version
1286Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
2df3850c
JM
1287information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1288@value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1289version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1290commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1291system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1292variant versions of @value{GDBN} in GNU/Linux distributions as well.
1293The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1294@value{GDBN}.
c906108c
SS
1295
1296@kindex show copying
1297@item show copying
1298Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1299
1300@kindex show warranty
1301@item show warranty
2df3850c
JM
1302Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1303if your version of @value{GDB} comes with one.
1304
c906108c
SS
1305@end table
1306
53a5351d 1307@node Running
c906108c
SS
1308@chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1309
1310When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1311debugging information when you compile it.
7a292a7a
SS
1312
1313You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1314of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1315your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1316kill a child process.
c906108c
SS
1317
1318@menu
1319* Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1320* Starting:: Starting your program
c906108c
SS
1321* Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1322* Environment:: Your program's environment
c906108c
SS
1323
1324* Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1325* Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1326* Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1327* Kill Process:: Killing the child process
c906108c
SS
1328
1329* Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1330* Processes:: Debugging programs with multiple processes
1331@end menu
1332
53a5351d 1333@node Compilation
c906108c
SS
1334@section Compiling for debugging
1335
1336In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1337debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1338is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1339variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1340and addresses in the executable code.
1341
1342To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1343the compiler.
1344
1345Many C compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O}
1346options together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1347executables containing debugging information.
1348
53a5351d
JM
1349@value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1350without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1351recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1352program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1353in pushing your luck.
c906108c
SS
1354
1355@cindex optimized code, debugging
1356@cindex debugging optimized code
1357When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
1358optimizer is rearranging your code; the debugger shows you what is
1359really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
1360exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
1361variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
1362variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
1363
1364Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
1365@samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
1366doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
1367please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
1368
1369Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1370@w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1371format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1372
1373@need 2000
53a5351d 1374@node Starting
c906108c
SS
1375@section Starting your program
1376@cindex starting
1377@cindex running
1378
1379@table @code
1380@kindex run
1381@item run
1382@itemx r
7a292a7a
SS
1383Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1384You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1385argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1386@value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1387(@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
c906108c
SS
1388
1389@end table
1390
c906108c
SS
1391If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1392supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1393that process run your program. (In environments without processes,
1394@code{run} jumps to the start of your program.)
1395
1396The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1397receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1398information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
1399can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1400your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
1401divided into four categories:
1402
1403@table @asis
1404@item The @emph{arguments.}
1405Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
1406@code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
1407is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
1408(such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
1409the arguments.
1410In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
1411@code{SHELL} environment variable.
1412@xref{Arguments, ,Your program's arguments}.
1413
1414@item The @emph{environment.}
1415Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
1416use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
1417environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
1418your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}.
1419
1420@item The @emph{working directory.}
1421Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
1422the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
1423@xref{Working Directory, ,Your program's working directory}.
1424
1425@item The @emph{standard input and output.}
1426Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
1427standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
1428in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
1429set a different device for your program.
1430@xref{Input/Output, ,Your program's input and output}.
1431
1432@cindex pipes
1433@emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
1434pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
1435program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
1436wrong program.
1437@end table
c906108c
SS
1438
1439When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
1440immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and continuing}, for discussion
1441of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
1442stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
1443or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
1444
1445If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
1446time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
1447table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
1448your current breakpoints.
1449
53a5351d 1450@node Arguments
c906108c
SS
1451@section Your program's arguments
1452
1453@cindex arguments (to your program)
1454The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
1455@code{run} command.
1456They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
1457performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
1458@code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
1459@value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
d4f3574e
SS
1460the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
1461
1462On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
1463@value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
1464calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
1465the program, not by the shell.
c906108c
SS
1466
1467@code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
1468@code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
1469
1470@kindex set args
1471@table @code
1472@item set args
1473Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
1474@code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
1475with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
1476using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
1477it again without arguments.
1478
1479@kindex show args
1480@item show args
1481Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
1482@end table
1483
53a5351d 1484@node Environment
c906108c
SS
1485@section Your program's environment
1486
1487@cindex environment (of your program)
1488The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
1489their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
1490your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
1491path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
1492the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
1493debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
1494environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
1495
1496@table @code
1497@kindex path
1498@item path @var{directory}
1499Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
1500(the search path for executables), for both @value{GDBN} and your program.
d4f3574e
SS
1501You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
1502system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
1503MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
1504is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
c906108c
SS
1505
1506You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
1507working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
1508use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
1509@code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
1510@var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
1511@var{directory} to the search path.
1512@c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
1513@c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
1514
1515@kindex show paths
1516@item show paths
1517Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
1518environment variable).
1519
1520@kindex show environment
1521@item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
1522Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
1523your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
1524print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
1525your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
1526
1527@kindex set environment
53a5351d 1528@item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
c906108c
SS
1529Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
1530changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may
1531be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
1532any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
1533parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
1534null value.
1535@c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
1536@c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
1537
1538For example, this command:
1539
1540@example
1541set env USER = foo
1542@end example
1543
1544@noindent
d4f3574e 1545tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
c906108c
SS
1546@samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
1547are not actually required.)
1548
1549@kindex unset environment
1550@item unset environment @var{varname}
1551Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
1552program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
1553@code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
1554rather than assigning it an empty value.
1555@end table
1556
d4f3574e
SS
1557@emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
1558the shell indicated
c906108c
SS
1559by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
1560@code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
1561that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
1562@file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
1563your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
1564files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
1565@file{.profile}.
1566
53a5351d 1567@node Working Directory
c906108c
SS
1568@section Your program's working directory
1569
1570@cindex working directory (of your program)
1571Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
1572working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
1573The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
1574from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
1575working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
1576
1577The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
1578that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
1579specify files}.
1580
1581@table @code
1582@kindex cd
1583@item cd @var{directory}
1584Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.
1585
1586@kindex pwd
1587@item pwd
1588Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
1589@end table
1590
53a5351d 1591@node Input/Output
c906108c
SS
1592@section Your program's input and output
1593
1594@cindex redirection
1595@cindex i/o
1596@cindex terminal
1597By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
1598the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
1599to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
1600modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
1601running your program.
1602
1603@table @code
1604@kindex info terminal
1605@item info terminal
1606Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
1607program is using.
1608@end table
1609
1610You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
1611redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
1612
1613@example
1614run > outfile
1615@end example
1616
1617@noindent
1618starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
1619
1620@kindex tty
1621@cindex controlling terminal
1622Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
1623with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
1624argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
1625commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
1626process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
1627
1628@example
1629tty /dev/ttyb
1630@end example
1631
1632@noindent
1633directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
1634default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
1635that as their controlling terminal.
1636
1637An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
1638effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
1639terminal.
1640
1641When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
1642command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
1643for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal.
1644
53a5351d 1645@node Attach
c906108c
SS
1646@section Debugging an already-running process
1647@kindex attach
1648@cindex attach
1649
1650@table @code
1651@item attach @var{process-id}
1652This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
1653outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
1654targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
1655find out the process-id of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
1656or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
1657
1658@code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
1659executing the command.
1660@end table
1661
1662To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
1663which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
1664programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
1665also have permission to send the process a signal.
1666
1667When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
1668the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
1669the program is not found) by using the source file search path
1670(@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying source directories}). You can also use
1671the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
1672Specify Files}.
1673
1674The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
1675process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
53a5351d
JM
1676with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
1677you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
1678can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
1679process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
c906108c
SS
1680attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
1681
1682@table @code
1683@kindex detach
1684@item detach
1685When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
1686@code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
1687the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
1688that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
1689are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
1690@code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
1691executing the command.
1692@end table
1693
1694If you exit @value{GDBN} or use the @code{run} command while you have an
1695attached process, you kill that process. By default, @value{GDBN} asks
1696for confirmation if you try to do either of these things; you can
1697control whether or not you need to confirm by using the @code{set
1698confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
1699messages}).
1700
53a5351d 1701@node Kill Process
c906108c 1702@section Killing the child process
c906108c
SS
1703
1704@table @code
1705@kindex kill
1706@item kill
1707Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
1708@end table
1709
1710This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
1711running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
1712is running.
1713
1714On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
1715while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
1716@code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
1717outside the debugger.
1718
1719The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
1720relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
1721executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
1722next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
1723reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
1724breakpoint settings).
1725
53a5351d 1726@node Threads
c906108c 1727@section Debugging programs with multiple threads
c906108c
SS
1728
1729@cindex threads of execution
1730@cindex multiple threads
1731@cindex switching threads
1732In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
1733may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
1734of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
1735the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
1736that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
1737modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
1738registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
1739
1740@value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
1741programs:
1742
1743@itemize @bullet
1744@item automatic notification of new threads
1745@item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
1746@item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
1747@item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
1748a command to apply a command to a list of threads
1749@item thread-specific breakpoints
1750@end itemize
1751
c906108c
SS
1752@quotation
1753@emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
1754@value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
1755If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
1756effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
1757from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
1758like this:
1759
1760@smallexample
1761(@value{GDBP}) info threads
1762(@value{GDBP}) thread 1
1763Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
1764see the IDs of currently known threads.
1765@end smallexample
1766@c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
1767@c doesn't support threads"?
1768@end quotation
c906108c
SS
1769
1770@cindex focus of debugging
1771@cindex current thread
1772The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
1773threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
1774control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
1775This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
1776program information from the perspective of the current thread.
1777
c906108c
SS
1778@kindex New @var{systag}
1779@cindex thread identifier (system)
1780@c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
1781@c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
1782@c thread without first checking `info threads'.
1783Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
1784the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
1785form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
1786whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
1787LynxOS, you might see
1788
1789@example
1790[New process 35 thread 27]
1791@end example
1792
1793@noindent
1794when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
1795the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
1796further qualifier.
1797
1798@c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
1799@c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
1800@c second---i.e., when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
1801@c program?
1802@c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
1803@c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
1804@c threads ab initio?
1805
1806@cindex thread number
1807@cindex thread identifier (GDB)
1808For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
1809number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
1810
1811@table @code
1812@kindex info threads
1813@item info threads
1814Display a summary of all threads currently in your
1815program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
1816
1817@enumerate
1818@item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
1819
1820@item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
1821
1822@item the current stack frame summary for that thread
1823@end enumerate
1824
1825@noindent
1826An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
1827indicates the current thread.
1828
1829For example,
1830@end table
1831@c end table here to get a little more width for example
1832
1833@smallexample
1834(@value{GDBP}) info threads
1835 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
1836 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
1837* 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
1838 at threadtest.c:68
1839@end smallexample
53a5351d
JM
1840
1841On HP-UX systems:
c906108c
SS
1842
1843@cindex thread number
1844@cindex thread identifier (GDB)
1845For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
1846number---a small integer assigned in thread-creation order---with each
1847thread in your program.
1848
1849@kindex New @var{systag}
1850@cindex thread identifier (system)
1851@c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
1852@c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
1853@c thread without first checking `info threads'.
1854Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
1855both @value{GDBN}'s thread number and the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
1856form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
1857whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
1858HP-UX, you see
1859
1860@example
1861[New thread 2 (system thread 26594)]
1862@end example
1863
1864@noindent
1865when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread.
1866
1867@table @code
1868@kindex info threads
1869@item info threads
1870Display a summary of all threads currently in your
1871program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
1872
1873@enumerate
1874@item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
1875
1876@item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
1877
1878@item the current stack frame summary for that thread
1879@end enumerate
1880
1881@noindent
1882An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
1883indicates the current thread.
1884
1885For example,
1886@end table
1887@c end table here to get a little more width for example
1888
1889@example
1890(@value{GDBP}) info threads
1891 * 3 system thread 26607 worker (wptr=0x7b09c318 "@@") at quicksort.c:137
1892 2 system thread 26606 0x7b0030d8 in __ksleep () from /usr/lib/libc.2
1893 1 system thread 27905 0x7b003498 in _brk () from /usr/lib/libc.2
1894@end example
c906108c
SS
1895
1896@table @code
1897@kindex thread @var{threadno}
1898@item thread @var{threadno}
1899Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
1900argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
1901shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
1902@value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
1903you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
1904
1905@smallexample
1906@c FIXME!! This example made up; find a @value{GDBN} w/threads and get real one
1907(@value{GDBP}) thread 2
c906108c 1908[Switching to process 35 thread 23]
c906108c
SS
19090x34e5 in sigpause ()
1910@end smallexample
1911
1912@noindent
1913As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
1914@samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
1915threads.
1916
1917@kindex thread apply
1918@item thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}
1919The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply a command to one or
1920more threads. Specify the numbers of the threads that you want affected
1921with the command argument @var{threadno}. @var{threadno} is the internal
1922@value{GDBN} thread number, as shown in the first field of the @samp{info
1923threads} display. To apply a command to all threads, use
1924@code{thread apply all} @var{args}.
1925@end table
1926
1927@cindex automatic thread selection
1928@cindex switching threads automatically
1929@cindex threads, automatic switching
1930Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
1931signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
1932signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
1933message of the form @samp{[Switching to @var{systag}]} to identify the
1934thread.
1935
1936@xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and starting multi-thread programs}, for
1937more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
1938programs with multiple threads.
1939
1940@xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting watchpoints}, for information about
1941watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
c906108c 1942
53a5351d 1943@node Processes
c906108c
SS
1944@section Debugging programs with multiple processes
1945
1946@cindex fork, debugging programs which call
1947@cindex multiple processes
1948@cindex processes, multiple
53a5351d
JM
1949On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
1950programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
1951function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
1952parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
1953set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
1954will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
1955will cause it to terminate.
c906108c
SS
1956
1957However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
1958which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
1959the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
1960only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
1961so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
1962on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
1963get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
1964@value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
d4f3574e 1965the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
c906108c 1966the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
c906108c 1967
53a5351d
JM
1968On HP-UX (11.x and later only?), @value{GDBN} provides support for
1969debugging programs that create additional processes using the
1970@code{fork} or @code{vfork} function.
c906108c
SS
1971
1972By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
1973the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
1974
1975If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
1976use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
1977
1978@table @code
1979@kindex set follow-fork-mode
1980@item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
1981Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
1982@code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
1983process. The @var{mode} can be:
1984
1985@table @code
1986@item parent
1987The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
2df3850c 1988unimpeded. This is the default.
c906108c
SS
1989
1990@item child
1991The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
1992unimpeded.
1993
1994@item ask
1995The debugger will ask for one of the above choices.
1996@end table
1997
1998@item show follow-fork-mode
2df3850c 1999Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
c906108c
SS
2000@end table
2001
2002If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
2003@code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
2004breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
2005@code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
2006the child process's @code{main}.
2007
2008When a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you cannot debug the
2009child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
2010
2011If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
2012call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent process,
2013use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name as its
2014argument.
2015
2016You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
2017a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
2018Catchpoints, ,Setting catchpoints}.
c906108c 2019
53a5351d 2020@node Stopping
c906108c
SS
2021@chapter Stopping and Continuing
2022
2023The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
2024program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
2025trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
2026
7a292a7a
SS
2027Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
2028such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
2029@value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
2030change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
2031continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
2032ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
2033explicitly request this information at any time.
c906108c
SS
2034
2035@table @code
2036@kindex info program
2037@item info program
2038Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
7a292a7a 2039running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
c906108c
SS
2040@end table
2041
2042@menu
2043* Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2044* Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
c906108c 2045* Signals:: Signals
c906108c 2046* Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
c906108c
SS
2047@end menu
2048
53a5351d 2049@node Breakpoints
c906108c
SS
2050@section Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2051
2052@cindex breakpoints
2053A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
2054the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
2055control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
2056breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
2057Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
2058should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
2059program.
2060
2061In HP-UX, SunOS 4.x, SVR4, and Alpha OSF/1 configurations, you can set
2062breakpoints in shared libraries before the executable is run. There is
2063a minor limitation on HP-UX systems: you must wait until the executable
2064is run in order to set breakpoints in shared library routines that are
2065not called directly by the program (for example, routines that are
2066arguments in a @code{pthread_create} call).
2067
2068@cindex watchpoints
2069@cindex memory tracing
2070@cindex breakpoint on memory address
2071@cindex breakpoint on variable modification
2072A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
2073when the value of an expression changes. You must use a different
2074command to set watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting
2075watchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a watchpoint like
2076any other breakpoint: you enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints
2077and watchpoints using the same commands.
2078
2079You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
2080whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
2081Automatic display}.
2082
2083@cindex catchpoints
2084@cindex breakpoint on events
2085A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
2086when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C++
2087exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
2088different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
2089catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
2090other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
d4f3574e 2091@code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
c906108c
SS
2092
2093@cindex breakpoint numbers
2094@cindex numbers for breakpoints
2095@value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2096catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
2097starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
2098features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
2099breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
2100@dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
2101enable it again.
2102
2103@menu
2104* Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
2105* Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
2106* Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
2107* Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
2108* Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
2109* Conditions:: Break conditions
2110* Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
c906108c 2111* Breakpoint Menus:: Breakpoint menus
d4f3574e 2112* Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
c906108c
SS
2113@end menu
2114
53a5351d 2115@node Set Breaks
c906108c
SS
2116@subsection Setting breakpoints
2117
2118@c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
2119@c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
2120@c
2121@c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
2122
2123@kindex break
2124@kindex b
2125@kindex $bpnum
2126@cindex latest breakpoint
2127Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
2128@code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
2129number of the breakpoints you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
2130Vars,, Convenience variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
2131convenience variables.
2132
2133You have several ways to say where the breakpoint should go.
2134
2135@table @code
2136@item break @var{function}
2137Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function}.
c906108c
SS
2138When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
2139C++, @var{function} may refer to more than one possible place to break.
2140@xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}, for a discussion of that situation.
c906108c
SS
2141
2142@item break +@var{offset}
2143@itemx break -@var{offset}
2144Set a breakpoint some number of lines forward or back from the position
d4f3574e 2145at which execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}.
2df3850c 2146(@xref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.)
c906108c
SS
2147
2148@item break @var{linenum}
2149Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in the current source file.
d4f3574e
SS
2150The current source file is the last file whose source text was printed.
2151The breakpoint will stop your program just before it executes any of the
c906108c
SS
2152code on that line.
2153
2154@item break @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2155Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in source file @var{filename}.
2156
2157@item break @var{filename}:@var{function}
2158Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function} found in file
2159@var{filename}. Specifying a file name as well as a function name is
2160superfluous except when multiple files contain similarly named
2161functions.
2162
2163@item break *@var{address}
2164Set a breakpoint at address @var{address}. You can use this to set
2165breakpoints in parts of your program which do not have debugging
2166information or source files.
2167
2168@item break
2169When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
2170the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
2171(@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
2172innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
2173returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
2174@code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
2175that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
2176@code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
2177the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
2178inside loops.
2179
2180@value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
2181least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
2182would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
2183breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
2184existed when your program stopped.
2185
2186@item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
2187Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
2188@var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
2189value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
2190@samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
2191above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
2192,Break conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
2193
2194@kindex tbreak
2195@item tbreak @var{args}
2196Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
2197same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
2198way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
2199program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
2200
c906108c
SS
2201@kindex hbreak
2202@item hbreak @var{args}
d4f3574e
SS
2203Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
2204@code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
c906108c
SS
2205breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
2206have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
d4f3574e
SS
2207debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
2208changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
2209provided by SPARClite DSU and some x86-based targets. These targets
2210will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
2211address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
2212breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
2213example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
2214@value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
2215or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
2216(@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling}). @xref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
c906108c
SS
2217
2218@kindex thbreak
2219@item thbreak @var{args}
2220Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
2221are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
2222the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
2223the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
2224first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
2225command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
2226may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
d4f3574e 2227See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
c906108c
SS
2228
2229@kindex rbreak
2230@cindex regular expression
2231@item rbreak @var{regex}
2232@c FIXME what kind of regexp?
2233Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
2234@var{regex}. This command
2235sets an unconditional breakpoint on all matches, printing a list of all
2236breakpoints it set. Once these breakpoints are set, they are treated
2237just like the breakpoints set with the @code{break} command. You can
2238delete them, disable them, or make them conditional the same way as any
2239other breakpoint.
2240
c906108c
SS
2241When debugging C++ programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
2242breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
2243classes.
c906108c
SS
2244
2245@kindex info breakpoints
2246@cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
2247@item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2248@itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2249@itemx info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2250Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
2251not deleted, with the following columns for each breakpoint:
2252
2253@table @emph
2254@item Breakpoint Numbers
2255@item Type
2256Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
2257@item Disposition
2258Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
2259@item Enabled or Disabled
2260Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
2261that are not enabled.
2262@item Address
2df3850c 2263Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address.
c906108c
SS
2264@item What
2265Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
2266line number.
2267@end table
2268
2269@noindent
2270If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on
2271the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any,
2272are listed after that.
2273
2274@noindent
2275@code{info break} with a breakpoint
2276number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
2277convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
2278the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
2279listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}).
2280
2281@noindent
2282@code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
2283has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
2284@code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
2285hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
2286was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
2287will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
2288@end table
2289
2290@value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
2291your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
2292the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
2293(@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
2294
2295@cindex negative breakpoint numbers
2296@cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
2297@value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for special
2298purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C programs).
2299These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers, starting with
2300@code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
2301
2302You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
2303@samp{maint info breakpoints}.
2304
2305@table @code
2306@kindex maint info breakpoints
2307@item maint info breakpoints
2308Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
2309breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
2310internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
2311breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
2312is shown:
2313
2314@table @code
2315@item breakpoint
2316Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
2317
2318@item watchpoint
2319Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
2320
2321@item longjmp
2322Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
2323@code{longjmp} calls.
2324
2325@item longjmp resume
2326Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
2327
2328@item until
2329Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
2330
2331@item finish
2332Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
2333
c906108c
SS
2334@item shlib events
2335Shared library events.
53a5351d 2336
c906108c 2337@end table
53a5351d 2338
c906108c
SS
2339@end table
2340
2341
53a5351d 2342@node Set Watchpoints
c906108c
SS
2343@subsection Setting watchpoints
2344
2345@cindex setting watchpoints
2346@cindex software watchpoints
2347@cindex hardware watchpoints
2348You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
2349expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
2350this may happen.
2351
2352Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
2df3850c 2353hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
c906108c
SS
2354program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
2355times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
2356catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
2357culprit.)
2358
d4f3574e 2359On some systems, such as HP-UX, Linux and some other x86-based targets,
2df3850c 2360@value{GDBN} includes support for
c906108c
SS
2361hardware watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your
2362program.
2363
2364@table @code
2365@kindex watch
2366@item watch @var{expr}
2367Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when @var{expr}
2368is written into by the program and its value changes.
2369
2370@kindex rwatch
2371@item rwatch @var{expr}
2372Set a watchpoint that will break when watch @var{expr} is read by the program.
c906108c
SS
2373
2374@kindex awatch
2375@item awatch @var{expr}
2df3850c 2376Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read or written into
7be570e7 2377by the program.
c906108c
SS
2378
2379@kindex info watchpoints
2380@item info watchpoints
2381This command prints a list of watchpoints, breakpoints, and catchpoints;
2382it is the same as @code{info break}.
2383@end table
2384
2385@value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
2386watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
2387value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
2388cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
2389executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
2390statement, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
2391
2392When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
2393
2394@example
2395Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
2396@end example
2397
2398@noindent
2399if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
2400
7be570e7
JM
2401Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
2402hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
2403value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
2404every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
2405that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
2406hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
2407will print a message like this:
2408
2409@smallexample
2410Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
2411@end smallexample
2412
2413Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
2414data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
2415watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
2416can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
2417cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
2418double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
2419wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
2420into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
2421
2422If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
2423to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
2424Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
2425time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
2426able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
2427warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
2428
2429@smallexample
2430Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
2431@end smallexample
2432
2433@noindent
2434If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
2435
2436The SPARClite DSU will generate traps when a program accesses some data
2437or instruction address that is assigned to the debug registers. For the
2438data addresses, DSU facilitates the @code{watch} command. However the
2439hardware breakpoint registers can only take two data watchpoints, and
2440both watchpoints must be the same kind. For example, you can set two
2441watchpoints with @code{watch} commands, two with @code{rwatch} commands,
2442@strong{or} two with @code{awatch} commands, but you cannot set one
2443watchpoint with one command and the other with a different command.
c906108c
SS
2444@value{GDBN} will reject the command if you try to mix watchpoints.
2445Delete or disable unused watchpoint commands before setting new ones.
2446
2447If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
2df3850c 2448any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
c906108c
SS
2449kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
2450
7be570e7
JM
2451@value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
2452(automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
2453they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
2454which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
2455being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
2456and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
2457rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
2458way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
2459@code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
2460
c906108c
SS
2461@quotation
2462@cindex watchpoints and threads
2463@cindex threads and watchpoints
c906108c
SS
2464@emph{Warning:} In multi-thread programs, watchpoints have only limited
2465usefulness. With the current watchpoint implementation, @value{GDBN}
2466can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a single thread}. If
2467you are confident that the expression can only change due to the current
2468thread's activity (and if you are also confident that no other thread
2469can become current), then you can use watchpoints as usual. However,
2470@value{GDBN} may not notice when a non-current thread's activity changes
2471the expression.
53a5351d 2472
d4f3574e 2473@c FIXME: this is almost identical to the previous paragraph.
53a5351d
JM
2474@emph{HP-UX Warning:} In multi-thread programs, software watchpoints
2475have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
2476watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
2477single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
2478change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
2479confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
2480software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
2481when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
2482watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
c906108c 2483@end quotation
c906108c 2484
53a5351d 2485@node Set Catchpoints
c906108c 2486@subsection Setting catchpoints
d4f3574e 2487@cindex catchpoints, setting
c906108c
SS
2488@cindex exception handlers
2489@cindex event handling
2490
2491You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
2492kinds of program events, such as C++ exceptions or the loading of a
2493shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
2494
2495@table @code
2496@kindex catch
2497@item catch @var{event}
2498Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
2499@table @code
2500@item throw
2501@kindex catch throw
2502The throwing of a C++ exception.
2503
2504@item catch
2505@kindex catch catch
2506The catching of a C++ exception.
2507
2508@item exec
2509@kindex catch exec
2510A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2511
2512@item fork
2513@kindex catch fork
2514A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2515
2516@item vfork
2517@kindex catch vfork
2518A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2519
2520@item load
2521@itemx load @var{libname}
2522@kindex catch load
2523The dynamic loading of any shared library, or the loading of the library
2524@var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2525
2526@item unload
2527@itemx unload @var{libname}
2528@kindex catch unload
2529The unloading of any dynamically loaded shared library, or the unloading
2530of the library @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2531@end table
2532
2533@item tcatch @var{event}
2534Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
2535automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
2536
2537@end table
2538
2539Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
2540
2541There are currently some limitations to C++ exception handling
2542(@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
2543
2544@itemize @bullet
2545@item
2546If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
2547control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
2548raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
2549returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
2550simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
2551that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
2552you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
2553disabled within interactive calls.
2554
2555@item
2556You cannot raise an exception interactively.
2557
2558@item
2559You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
2560@end itemize
2561
2562@cindex raise exceptions
2563Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
2564if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
2565stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
2566can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a
2567breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
2568out where the exception was raised.
2569
2570To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
2571knowledge of the implementation. In the case of @sc{gnu} C++, exceptions are
2572raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
2573which has the following ANSI C interface:
2574
2575@example
2576 /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
d4f3574e
SS
2577 @var{id} is the exception identifier. */
2578 void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id);
c906108c
SS
2579@end example
2580
2581@noindent
2582To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
2583unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
2584(@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and exceptions}).
2585
2586With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions})
2587that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
2588a specific exception is raised. You can use multiple conditional
2589breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
2590raised.
2591
2592
53a5351d 2593@node Delete Breaks
c906108c
SS
2594@subsection Deleting breakpoints
2595
2596@cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
2597@cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
2598It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2599catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
2600to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
2601breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
2602
2603With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
2604where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
2605delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
2606their breakpoint numbers.
2607
2608It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
2609automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
2610when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
2611
2612@table @code
2613@kindex clear
2614@item clear
2615Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
2616selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). When
2617the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
2618breakpoint where your program just stopped.
2619
2620@item clear @var{function}
2621@itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
2622Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the function @var{function}.
2623
2624@item clear @var{linenum}
2625@itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2626Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified line.
2627
2628@cindex delete breakpoints
2629@kindex delete
2630@kindex d
2631@item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{bnums}@dots{}@r{]}
2632Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the numbers
2633specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
2634breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
2635confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
2636@end table
2637
53a5351d 2638@node Disabling
c906108c
SS
2639@subsection Disabling breakpoints
2640
2641@kindex disable breakpoints
2642@kindex enable breakpoints
2643Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
2644prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
2645it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
2646that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
2647
2648You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
2649the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying one
2650or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} or
2651@code{info watch} to print a list of breakpoints, watchpoints, and
2652catchpoints if you do not know which numbers to use.
2653
2654A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different
2655states of enablement:
2656
2657@itemize @bullet
2658@item
2659Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
2660with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
2661@item
2662Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
2663@item
2664Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
d4f3574e 2665disabled.
c906108c
SS
2666@item
2667Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
d4f3574e
SS
2668immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
2669set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
c906108c
SS
2670@end itemize
2671
2672You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
2673watchpoints, and catchpoints:
2674
2675@table @code
2676@kindex disable breakpoints
2677@kindex disable
2678@kindex dis
2679@item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{bnums}@dots{}@r{]}
2680Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
2681listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
2682options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
2683case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
2684@code{disable} as @code{dis}.
2685
2686@kindex enable breakpoints
2687@kindex enable
2688@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{bnums}@dots{}@r{]}
2689Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
2690become effective once again in stopping your program.
2691
2692@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{bnums}@dots{}
2693Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
2694of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
2695
2696@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{bnums}@dots{}
2697Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
2698deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
2699@end table
2700
d4f3574e
SS
2701@c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
2702@c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
c906108c
SS
2703Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
2704,Setting breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
2705subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
2706the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
2707breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
2708breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
2709stepping}.)
2710
53a5351d 2711@node Conditions
c906108c
SS
2712@subsection Break conditions
2713@cindex conditional breakpoints
2714@cindex breakpoint conditions
2715
2716@c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
2717@c in particular for a watchpoint?
2718The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
2719specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
2720breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
2721programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
2722a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
2723and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
2724
2725This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
2726situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
2727when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
2728by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
2729@samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
2730
2731Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
2732since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
2733it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
2734and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
2735one.
2736
2737Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
2738your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
2739that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
2740format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
2741unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
2742that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
2743program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
d4f3574e
SS
2744breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
2745conditions for the
c906108c
SS
2746purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
2747(@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint command lists}).
2748
2749Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
2750@samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
2751Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
2752with the @code{condition} command.
53a5351d 2753
c906108c
SS
2754You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
2755The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
2756@code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
2757catchpoint.
c906108c
SS
2758
2759@table @code
2760@kindex condition
2761@item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
2762Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
2763watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
2764breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
2765@var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
2766@code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
2767syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
d4f3574e
SS
2768referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
2769symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
2770prints an error message:
2771
2772@example
2773No symbol "foo" in current context.
2774@end example
2775
2776@noindent
c906108c
SS
2777@value{GDBN} does
2778not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
d4f3574e
SS
2779command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
2780@code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
c906108c
SS
2781
2782@item condition @var{bnum}
2783Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
2784an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
2785@end table
2786
2787@cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
2788A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
2789breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
2790useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
2791count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
2792is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
2793therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
2794ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
2795the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
2796value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
2797your program reaches it.
2798
2799@table @code
2800@kindex ignore
2801@item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
2802Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
2803The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
2804execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
2805takes no action.
2806
2807To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
2808a count of zero.
2809
2810When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
2811breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
2812@code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
2813Stepping,,Continuing and stepping}.
2814
2815If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
2816condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
2817@value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
2818
2819You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
2820as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
2821is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
2822variables}.
2823@end table
2824
2825Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
2826
2827
53a5351d 2828@node Break Commands
c906108c
SS
2829@subsection Breakpoint command lists
2830
2831@cindex breakpoint commands
2832You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
2833commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
2834example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
2835enable other breakpoints.
2836
2837@table @code
2838@kindex commands
2839@kindex end
2840@item commands @r{[}@var{bnum}@r{]}
2841@itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
2842@itemx end
2843Specify a list of commands for breakpoint number @var{bnum}. The commands
2844themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
2845@code{end} to terminate the commands.
2846
2847To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
2848follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
2849
2850With no @var{bnum} argument, @code{commands} refers to the last
2851breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most
2852recently encountered).
2853@end table
2854
2855Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
2856disabled within a @var{command-list}.
2857
2858You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
2859use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
2860that resumes execution.
2861
2862Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
2863execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
2864(even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
2865another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
2866ambiguities about which list to execute.
2867
2868@kindex silent
2869If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
2870usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
2871be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
2872then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
2873see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
2874meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
2875
2876The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
2877print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
2878breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for controlled output}.
2879
2880For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
2881value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
2882
2883@example
2884break foo if x>0
2885commands
2886silent
2887printf "x is %d\n",x
2888cont
2889end
2890@end example
2891
2892One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
2893you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
2894of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
2895erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
2896to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
2897so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
2898command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
2899
2900@example
2901break 403
2902commands
2903silent
2904set x = y + 4
2905cont
2906end
2907@end example
2908
53a5351d 2909@node Breakpoint Menus
c906108c
SS
2910@subsection Breakpoint menus
2911@cindex overloading
2912@cindex symbol overloading
2913
2914Some programming languages (notably C++) permit a single function name
2915to be defined several times, for application in different contexts.
2916This is called @dfn{overloading}. When a function name is overloaded,
2917@samp{break @var{function}} is not enough to tell @value{GDBN} where you want
2918a breakpoint. If you realize this is a problem, you can use
2919something like @samp{break @var{function}(@var{types})} to specify which
2920particular version of the function you want. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} offers
2921you a menu of numbered choices for different possible breakpoints, and
2922waits for your selection with the prompt @samp{>}. The first two
2923options are always @samp{[0] cancel} and @samp{[1] all}. Typing @kbd{1}
2924sets a breakpoint at each definition of @var{function}, and typing
2925@kbd{0} aborts the @code{break} command without setting any new
2926breakpoints.
2927
2928For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
2929breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
2930We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
2931
2932@c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
2933@smallexample
2934@group
2935(@value{GDBP}) b String::after
2936[0] cancel
2937[1] all
2938[2] file:String.cc; line number:867
2939[3] file:String.cc; line number:860
2940[4] file:String.cc; line number:875
2941[5] file:String.cc; line number:853
2942[6] file:String.cc; line number:846
2943[7] file:String.cc; line number:735
2944> 2 4 6
2945Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
2946Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
2947Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
2948Multiple breakpoints were set.
2949Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
2950 breakpoints.
2951(@value{GDBP})
2952@end group
2953@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
2954
2955@c @ifclear BARETARGET
d4f3574e
SS
2956@node Error in Breakpoints
2957@subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
c906108c
SS
2958@c
2959@c FIXME!! 14/6/95 Is there a real example of this? Let's use it.
2960@c
d4f3574e
SS
2961Under some operating systems, breakpoints cannot be used in a program if
2962any other process is running that program. In this situation,
2963attempting to run or continue a program with a breakpoint causes
2964@value{GDBN} to print an error message:
2965
2966@example
2967Cannot insert breakpoints.
2968The same program may be running in another process.
2969@end example
2970
2971When this happens, you have three ways to proceed:
2972
2973@enumerate
2974@item
2975Remove or disable the breakpoints, then continue.
2976
2977@item
2978Suspend @value{GDBN}, and copy the file containing your program to a new
2979name. Resume @value{GDBN} and use the @code{exec-file} command to specify
2980that @value{GDBN} should run your program under that name.
2981Then start your program again.
2982
2983@item
2984Relink your program so that the text segment is nonsharable, using the
2985linker option @samp{-N}. The operating system limitation may not apply
2986to nonsharable executables.
2987@end enumerate
c906108c
SS
2988@c @end ifclear
2989
d4f3574e
SS
2990A similar message can be printed if you request too many active
2991hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints:
2992
2993@c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
2994@c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
2995@smallexample
2996Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
2997You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
2998@end smallexample
2999
3000@noindent
3001This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
3002only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
3003watchpoints it needs to insert.
3004
3005When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
3006hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
3007
3008
53a5351d 3009@node Continuing and Stepping
c906108c
SS
3010@section Continuing and stepping
3011
3012@cindex stepping
3013@cindex continuing
3014@cindex resuming execution
3015@dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
3016completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
3017one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
3018line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
7a292a7a
SS
3019particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
3020your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
d4f3574e
SS
3021it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
3022@samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
c906108c
SS
3023
3024@table @code
3025@kindex continue
3026@kindex c
3027@kindex fg
3028@item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3029@itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3030@itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3031Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
3032any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
3033@var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
3034ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
3035@code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
3036
3037The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
3038stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
3039@code{continue} is ignored.
3040
d4f3574e
SS
3041The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
3042debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
3043purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
3044@code{continue}.
c906108c
SS
3045@end table
3046
3047To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
3048(@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}) to go back to the
3049calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
3050different address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
3051
3052A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
3053(@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and catchpoints}) at the
3054beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
3055is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
3056and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
3057interesting, until you see the problem happen.
3058
3059@table @code
3060@kindex step
3061@kindex s
3062@item step
3063Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
3064line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
3065abbreviated @code{s}.
3066
3067@quotation
3068@c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
3069@c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
3070@c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
3071@c distinction here.
3072@emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
3073within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
3074execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
3075debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
3076is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
3077without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
3078below.
3079@end quotation
3080
d4f3574e
SS
3081The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a
3082source line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
c906108c
SS
3083switch statements, for loops, etc. @code{step} continues to stop if a
3084function that has debugging information is called within the line.
d4f3574e
SS
3085In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions called
3086within the line.
c906108c 3087
d4f3574e
SS
3088Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
3089number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
c906108c
SS
3090@code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
3091on MIPS machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
3092was any debugging information about the routine.
3093
3094@item step @var{count}
3095Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
7a292a7a
SS
3096breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
3097@var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
c906108c
SS
3098
3099@kindex next
3100@kindex n
3101@item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
3102Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
7a292a7a
SS
3103This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
3104the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
3105control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
3106that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
3107is abbreviated @code{n}.
c906108c
SS
3108
3109An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
3110
3111
3112@c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
3113@c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
3114@c
3115@c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
3116@c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
3117@c function are executed without stopping.
3118
d4f3574e
SS
3119The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
3120source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
c906108c
SS
3121switch statements, for loops, etc.
3122
3123@kindex finish
3124@item finish
3125Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
3126returns. Print the returned value (if any).
3127
3128Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
3129,Returning from a function}).
3130
3131@kindex until
3132@kindex u
3133@item until
3134@itemx u
3135Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
3136current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
3137stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
3138command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
3139automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
3140than the address of the jump.
3141
3142This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
3143though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
3144exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
3145simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
3146through the next iteration.
3147
3148@code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
3149stack frame.
3150
3151@code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
3152of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
3153example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
3154(@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
3155@code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
3156
3157@example
3158(@value{GDBP}) f
3159#0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
3160206 expand_input();
3161(@value{GDBP}) until
3162195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
3163@end example
3164
3165This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
3166generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
3167start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
3168written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
3169to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
3170expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
3171statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
3172
3173@code{until} with no argument works by means of single
3174instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
3175argument.
3176
3177@item until @var{location}
3178@itemx u @var{location}
3179Continue running your program until either the specified location is
3180reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
3181the forms of argument acceptable to @code{break} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
3182,Setting breakpoints}). This form of the command uses breakpoints,
3183and hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument.
3184
3185@kindex stepi
3186@kindex si
3187@item stepi
3188@itemx si
3189Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
3190
3191It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
3192instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
3193instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
3194Display,, Automatic display}.
3195
3196An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
3197
3198@need 750
3199@kindex nexti
3200@kindex ni
3201@item nexti
3202@itemx ni
3203Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
3204proceed until the function returns.
3205
3206An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
3207@end table
3208
53a5351d 3209@node Signals
c906108c
SS
3210@section Signals
3211@cindex signals
3212
3213A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
3214operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
3215kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
d4f3574e 3216signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{C-c});
c906108c
SS
3217@code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
3218memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
3219the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
3220requested an alarm).
3221
3222@cindex fatal signals
3223Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
3224functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
d4f3574e 3225errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
c906108c
SS
3226program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
3227@code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
3228fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
3229
3230@value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
3231program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
3232signal.
3233
3234@cindex handling signals
3235Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to ignore non-erroneous signals like @code{SIGALRM}
3236(so as not to interfere with their role in the functioning of your program)
3237but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
3238You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
3239
3240@table @code
3241@kindex info signals
3242@item info signals
3243Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
3244handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
3245the defined types of signals.
3246
d4f3574e 3247@code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
c906108c
SS
3248
3249@kindex handle
3250@item handle @var{signal} @var{keywords}@dots{}
3251Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can
3252be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the @samp{SIG} at the
3253beginning). The @var{keywords} say what change to make.
3254@end table
3255
3256@c @group
3257The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
3258Their full names are:
3259
3260@table @code
3261@item nostop
3262@value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
3263still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
3264
3265@item stop
3266@value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
3267the @code{print} keyword as well.
3268
3269@item print
3270@value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
3271
3272@item noprint
3273@value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
3274implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
3275
3276@item pass
3277@value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
3278can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
3279and not handled.
3280
3281@item nopass
3282@value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
3283@end table
3284@c @end group
3285
d4f3574e
SS
3286When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
3287program until you
c906108c
SS
3288continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
3289effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
3290after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
3291command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
3292program sees that signal when you continue.
3293
3294You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
3295seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
3296or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
3297due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
3298values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
3299execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
3300a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
3301you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
3302program a signal}.
c906108c 3303
53a5351d 3304@node Thread Stops
c906108c
SS
3305@section Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3306
3307When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
3308programs with multiple threads}), you can choose whether to set
3309breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
3310
3311@table @code
3312@cindex breakpoints and threads
3313@cindex thread breakpoints
3314@kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
3315@item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
3316@itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
3317@var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
3318writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
3319
3320Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
3321to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
3322particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
3323numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
3324column of the @samp{info threads} display.
3325
3326If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
3327breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
3328program.
3329
3330You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
3331well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before the
3332breakpoint condition, like this:
3333
3334@smallexample
2df3850c 3335(@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
c906108c
SS
3336@end smallexample
3337
3338@end table
3339
3340@cindex stopped threads
3341@cindex threads, stopped
3342Whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
3343@emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
3344allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
3345switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
3346underfoot.
3347
3348@cindex continuing threads
3349@cindex threads, continuing
3350Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
3351executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
3352like @code{step} or @code{next}.
3353
3354In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
3355Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
3356system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
3357execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
3358single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
3359statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
3360stops.
3361
3362You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
3363continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
3364thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
3365first thread completes whatever you requested.
3366
3367On some OSes, you can lock the OS scheduler and thus allow only a single
3368thread to run.
3369
3370@table @code
3371@item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
3372Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
3373locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
3374current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
3375mode optimizes for single-stepping. It stops other threads from
3376``seizing the prompt'' by preempting the current thread while you are
3377stepping. Other threads will only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
d4f3574e 3378when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
c906108c 3379function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
d4f3574e 3380like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
c906108c 3381thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, they will never steal the
2df3850c 3382@value{GDBN} prompt away from the thread that you are debugging.
c906108c
SS
3383
3384@item show scheduler-locking
3385Display the current scheduler locking mode.
3386@end table
3387
c906108c 3388
53a5351d 3389@node Stack
c906108c
SS
3390@chapter Examining the Stack
3391
3392When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
3393stopped and how it got there.
3394
3395@cindex call stack
3396Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
3397is generated.
3398That information includes the location of the call in your program,
3399the arguments of the call,
3400and the local variables of the function being called.
3401The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
3402The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
3403stack}.
3404
3405When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
3406stack allow you to see all of this information.
3407
3408@cindex selected frame
3409One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
3410@value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
3411particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
3412your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
3413special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
3414interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3415
3416When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
3417currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
3418@code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}).
3419
3420@menu
3421* Frames:: Stack frames
3422* Backtrace:: Backtraces
3423* Selection:: Selecting a frame
3424* Frame Info:: Information on a frame
c906108c
SS
3425
3426@end menu
3427
53a5351d 3428@node Frames
c906108c
SS
3429@section Stack frames
3430
d4f3574e 3431@cindex frame, definition
c906108c
SS
3432@cindex stack frame
3433The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
3434frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
3435with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
3436to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
3437which the function is executing.
3438
3439@cindex initial frame
3440@cindex outermost frame
3441@cindex innermost frame
3442When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
3443function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
3444@dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
3445made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
3446is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
3447the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
3448actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
3449recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
3450
3451@cindex frame pointer
3452Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
3453stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
3454kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
3455address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
3456in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register} while execution is
3457going on in that frame.
3458
3459@cindex frame number
3460@value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
3461zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
3462and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
3463they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
3464frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
3465
3466@c below produces an acceptable overful hbox. --mew 13aug1993
3467@cindex frameless execution
3468Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
3469without stack frames. (For example, the @code{@value{GCC}} option
3470@samp{-fomit-frame-pointer} generates functions without a frame.)
3471This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
3472the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
3473with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
3474has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
3475it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
3476correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
3477no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
3478
3479@table @code
d4f3574e 3480@kindex frame@r{, command}
c906108c
SS
3481@item frame @var{args}
3482The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
3483and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
3484address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
3485@code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
3486
3487@kindex select-frame
3488@item select-frame
3489The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
3490to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
3491@code{frame}.
3492@end table
3493
53a5351d 3494@node Backtrace
c906108c
SS
3495@section Backtraces
3496
3497@cindex backtraces
3498@cindex tracebacks
3499@cindex stack traces
3500A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
3501line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
3502frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
3503stack.
3504
3505@table @code
3506@kindex backtrace
3507@kindex bt
3508@item backtrace
3509@itemx bt
3510Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
3511frames in the stack.
3512
3513You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
3514character, normally @kbd{C-c}.
3515
3516@item backtrace @var{n}
3517@itemx bt @var{n}
3518Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
3519
3520@item backtrace -@var{n}
3521@itemx bt -@var{n}
3522Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
3523@end table
3524
3525@kindex where
3526@kindex info stack
3527@kindex info s
3528The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
3529are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
3530
3531Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
3532The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
3533print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
3534line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
3535counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
3536line number.
3537
3538Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
3539@samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
3540
3541@smallexample
3542@group
3543#0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
3544 at builtin.c:993
3545#1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600) at macro.c:242
3546#2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
3547 at macro.c:71
3548(More stack frames follow...)
3549@end group
3550@end smallexample
3551
3552@noindent
3553The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
3554value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
3555code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
3556
53a5351d 3557@node Selection
c906108c
SS
3558@section Selecting a frame
3559
3560Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
3561whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
3562selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
3563of the stack frame just selected.
3564
3565@table @code
d4f3574e 3566@kindex frame@r{, selecting}
c906108c
SS
3567@kindex f
3568@item frame @var{n}
3569@itemx f @var{n}
3570Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
3571(currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
3572innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
3573@code{main}.
3574
3575@item frame @var{addr}
3576@itemx f @var{addr}
3577Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
3578chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
3579impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
3580addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
3581switches between them.
3582
c906108c
SS
3583On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
3584select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
3585
3586On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
3587pointer and a program counter.
3588
3589On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
3590pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
3591@c note to future updaters: this is conditioned on a flag
3592@c SETUP_ARBITRARY_FRAME in the tm-*.h files. The above is up to date
3593@c as of 27 Jan 1994.
c906108c
SS
3594
3595@kindex up
3596@item up @var{n}
3597Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
3598advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
3599that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
3600
3601@kindex down
3602@kindex do
3603@item down @var{n}
3604Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
3605advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
3606that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
3607abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
3608@end table
3609
3610All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
3611frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
3612arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
3613frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
3614
3615@need 1000
3616For example:
3617
3618@smallexample
3619@group
3620(@value{GDBP}) up
3621#1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
3622 at env.c:10
362310 read_input_file (argv[i]);
3624@end group
3625@end smallexample
3626
3627After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
3628prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
3629@xref{List, ,Printing source lines}.
3630
3631@table @code
3632@kindex down-silently
3633@kindex up-silently
3634@item up-silently @var{n}
3635@itemx down-silently @var{n}
3636These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
3637respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
3638causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
3639in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
3640distracting.
3641@end table
3642
53a5351d 3643@node Frame Info
c906108c
SS
3644@section Information about a frame
3645
3646There are several other commands to print information about the selected
3647stack frame.
3648
3649@table @code
3650@item frame
3651@itemx f
3652When used without any argument, this command does not change which
3653frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
3654selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
3655argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
3656@xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3657
3658@kindex info frame
3659@kindex info f
3660@item info frame
3661@itemx info f
3662This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
3663including:
3664
3665@itemize @bullet
3666@item
3667the address of the frame
3668@item
3669the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
3670@item
3671the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
3672@item
3673the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
3674@item
3675the address of the frame's arguments
3676@item
d4f3574e
SS
3677the address of the frame's local variables
3678@item
c906108c
SS
3679the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
3680@item
3681which registers were saved in the frame
3682@end itemize
3683
3684@noindent The verbose description is useful when
3685something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
3686the usual conventions.
3687
3688@item info frame @var{addr}
3689@itemx info f @var{addr}
3690Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
3691selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
3692command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
3693architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
3694@xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3695
3696@kindex info args
3697@item info args
3698Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
3699
3700@item info locals
3701@kindex info locals
3702Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
3703line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
3704accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
3705
c906108c 3706@kindex info catch
d4f3574e
SS
3707@cindex catch exceptions, list active handlers
3708@cindex exception handlers, how to list
c906108c
SS
3709@item info catch
3710Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the
3711current stack frame at the current point of execution. To see other
3712exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up},
3713@code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}.
3714@xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
53a5351d 3715
c906108c
SS
3716@end table
3717
c906108c 3718
53a5351d 3719@node Source
c906108c
SS
3720@chapter Examining Source Files
3721
3722@value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
3723information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
3724used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
3725the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
3726(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
3727execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
3728source files by explicit command.
3729
7a292a7a 3730If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
d4f3574e 3731prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
7a292a7a 3732@value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
c906108c
SS
3733
3734@menu
3735* List:: Printing source lines
c906108c 3736* Search:: Searching source files
c906108c
SS
3737* Source Path:: Specifying source directories
3738* Machine Code:: Source and machine code
3739@end menu
3740
53a5351d 3741@node List
c906108c
SS
3742@section Printing source lines
3743
3744@kindex list
3745@kindex l
3746To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
3747(abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
3748There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to print.
3749
3750Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
3751
3752@table @code
3753@item list @var{linenum}
3754Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
3755current source file.
3756
3757@item list @var{function}
3758Print lines centered around the beginning of function
3759@var{function}.
3760
3761@item list
3762Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
3763@code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
3764printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
3765as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
3766Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
3767
3768@item list -
3769Print lines just before the lines last printed.
3770@end table
3771
3772By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
3773the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
3774
3775@table @code
3776@kindex set listsize
3777@item set listsize @var{count}
3778Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
3779the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
3780
3781@kindex show listsize
3782@item show listsize
3783Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
3784@end table
3785
3786Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
3787so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
3788than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
3789argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
3790each repetition moves up in the source file.
3791
3792@cindex linespec
3793In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
3794@dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
d4f3574e 3795of writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
c906108c
SS
3796Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
3797
3798@table @code
3799@item list @var{linespec}
3800Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
3801
3802@item list @var{first},@var{last}
3803Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
3804linespecs.
3805
3806@item list ,@var{last}
3807Print lines ending with @var{last}.
3808
3809@item list @var{first},
3810Print lines starting with @var{first}.
3811
3812@item list +
3813Print lines just after the lines last printed.
3814
3815@item list -
3816Print lines just before the lines last printed.
3817
3818@item list
3819As described in the preceding table.
3820@end table
3821
3822Here are the ways of specifying a single source line---all the
3823kinds of linespec.
3824
3825@table @code
3826@item @var{number}
3827Specifies line @var{number} of the current source file.
3828When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, this refers to
3829the same source file as the first linespec.
3830
3831@item +@var{offset}
3832Specifies the line @var{offset} lines after the last line printed.
3833When used as the second linespec in a @code{list} command that has
3834two, this specifies the line @var{offset} lines down from the
3835first linespec.
3836
3837@item -@var{offset}
3838Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before the last line printed.
3839
3840@item @var{filename}:@var{number}
3841Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
3842
3843@item @var{function}
3844Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
3845For example: in C, this is the line with the open brace.
3846
3847@item @var{filename}:@var{function}
3848Specifies the line of the open-brace that begins the body of the
3849function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
3850file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
3851identically named functions in different source files.
3852
3853@item *@var{address}
3854Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
3855@var{address} may be any expression.
3856@end table
3857
53a5351d 3858@node Search
c906108c
SS
3859@section Searching source files
3860@cindex searching
3861@kindex reverse-search
3862
3863There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
3864regular expression.
3865
3866@table @code
3867@kindex search
3868@kindex forward-search
3869@item forward-search @var{regexp}
3870@itemx search @var{regexp}
3871The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
3872starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
3873@var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
3874synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
3875@code{fo}.
3876
3877@item reverse-search @var{regexp}
3878The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
3879with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
3880for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
3881this command as @code{rev}.
3882@end table
c906108c 3883
53a5351d 3884@node Source Path
c906108c
SS
3885@section Specifying source directories
3886
3887@cindex source path
3888@cindex directories for source files
3889Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
3890files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
3891the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
3892session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
3893this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
3894it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
3895in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name. Note that
3896the executable search path is @emph{not} used for this purpose. Neither is
3897the current working directory, unless it happens to be in the source
3898path.
3899
3900If @value{GDBN} cannot find a source file in the source path, and the
3901object program records a directory, @value{GDBN} tries that directory
3902too. If the source path is empty, and there is no record of the
3903compilation directory, @value{GDBN} looks in the current directory as a
3904last resort.
3905
3906Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
3907any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
3908each line is in the file.
3909
3910@kindex directory
3911@kindex dir
d4f3574e
SS
3912When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
3913and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
c906108c
SS
3914To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
3915
3916@table @code
3917@item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
3918@item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
3919Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
d4f3574e
SS
3920directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
3921(@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
3922part of absolute file names) or
c906108c
SS
3923whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
3924path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
3925
3926@kindex cdir
3927@kindex cwd
3928@kindex $cdir
3929@kindex $cwd
3930@cindex compilation directory
3931@cindex current directory
3932@cindex working directory
3933@cindex directory, current
3934@cindex directory, compilation
3935You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
3936directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
3937working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
3938tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
3939session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
3940directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
3941
3942@item directory
3943Reset the source path to empty again. This requires confirmation.
3944
3945@c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
3946@c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
3947
3948@item show directories
3949@kindex show directories
3950Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
3951@end table
3952
3953If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
3954interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
3955versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
3956
3957@enumerate
3958@item
3959Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to empty.
3960
3961@item
3962Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
3963directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
3964directories in one command.
3965@end enumerate
3966
53a5351d 3967@node Machine Code
c906108c
SS
3968@section Source and machine code
3969
3970You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
3971addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
3972a range of addresses as machine instructions. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
d4f3574e 3973mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
c906108c
SS
3974line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
3975well as hex.
3976
3977@table @code
3978@kindex info line
3979@item info line @var{linespec}
3980Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
3981source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
3982the ways understood by the @code{list} command (@pxref{List, ,Printing
3983source lines}).
3984@end table
3985
3986For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
3987the object code for the first line of function
3988@code{m4_changequote}:
3989
d4f3574e
SS
3990@c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
3991@c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
c906108c
SS
3992@smallexample
3993(@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changecom
3994Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
3995@end smallexample
3996
3997@noindent
3998We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
3999@var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
4000@smallexample
4001(@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
4002Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
4003@end smallexample
4004
4005@cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
d4f3574e 4006@kindex x@r{, and }@code{info line}
c906108c
SS
4007After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
4008is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
4009sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
4010,Examining memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
4011convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4012variables}).
4013
4014@table @code
4015@kindex disassemble
4016@cindex assembly instructions
4017@cindex instructions, assembly
4018@cindex machine instructions
4019@cindex listing machine instructions
4020@item disassemble
4021This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
4022instructions. The default memory range is the function surrounding the
4023program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
4024command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
4025surrounding this value. Two arguments specify a range of addresses
4026(first inclusive, second exclusive) to dump.
4027@end table
4028
c906108c
SS
4029The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
4030HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
4031
4032@smallexample
4033(@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4 0x32e4
4034Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
40350x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
40360x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
40370x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
40380x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
40390x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
40400x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
40410x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
40420x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
4043End of assembler dump.
4044@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4045
4046Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
4047mnemonics or other syntax.
4048
4049@table @code
d4f3574e 4050@kindex set disassembly-flavor
c906108c
SS
4051@cindex assembly instructions
4052@cindex instructions, assembly
4053@cindex machine instructions
4054@cindex listing machine instructions
d4f3574e
SS
4055@cindex Intel disassembly flavor
4056@cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
4057@item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
c906108c
SS
4058Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
4059program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
4060
4061Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
d4f3574e
SS
4062can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
4063The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
4064assemblers for x86-based targets.
c906108c
SS
4065@end table
4066
4067
53a5351d 4068@node Data
c906108c
SS
4069@chapter Examining Data
4070
4071@cindex printing data
4072@cindex examining data
4073@kindex print
4074@kindex inspect
4075@c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
4076@c document because it is nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a
4077@c different window or something like that.
4078The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
7a292a7a
SS
4079command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
4080evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
4081program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
4082Different Languages}).
c906108c
SS
4083
4084@table @code
d4f3574e
SS
4085@item print @var{expr}
4086@itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
4087@var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
4088value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
c906108c 4089you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
d4f3574e 4090@var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
c906108c
SS
4091formats}.
4092
4093@item print
4094@itemx print /@var{f}
d4f3574e 4095If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
c906108c
SS
4096@dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value history}). This allows you to
4097conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
4098@end table
4099
4100A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
4101It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
4102specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
4103
7a292a7a 4104If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
d4f3574e
SS
4105fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
4106command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
7a292a7a 4107Table}.
c906108c
SS
4108
4109@menu
4110* Expressions:: Expressions
4111* Variables:: Program variables
4112* Arrays:: Artificial arrays
4113* Output Formats:: Output formats
4114* Memory:: Examining memory
4115* Auto Display:: Automatic display
4116* Print Settings:: Print settings
4117* Value History:: Value history
4118* Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
4119* Registers:: Registers
c906108c 4120* Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
c906108c
SS
4121@end menu
4122
53a5351d 4123@node Expressions
c906108c
SS
4124@section Expressions
4125
4126@cindex expressions
4127@code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
4128compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
4129by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
4130@value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls, casts
4131and string constants. It unfortunately does not include symbols defined
4132by preprocessor @code{#define} commands.
4133
d4f3574e
SS
4134@value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
4135the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
4136you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to build up an array in
4137memory that is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
c906108c 4138
c906108c
SS
4139Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
4140this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
4141Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
4142languages.
4143
4144In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
4145expressions regardless of your programming language.
4146
4147Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
4148useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
4149at that address in memory.
4150@c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
c906108c
SS
4151
4152@value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
4153to programming languages:
4154
4155@table @code
4156@item @@
4157@samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
4158@xref{Arrays, ,Artificial arrays}, for more information.
4159
4160@item ::
4161@samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
4162function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program variables}.
4163
4164@cindex @{@var{type}@}
4165@cindex type casting memory
4166@cindex memory, viewing as typed object
4167@cindex casts, to view memory
4168@item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
4169Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
4170memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
4171pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
4172a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
4173normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
4174@end table
4175
53a5351d 4176@node Variables
c906108c
SS
4177@section Program variables
4178
4179The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
4180in your program.
4181
4182Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
4183(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}); they must be either:
4184
4185@itemize @bullet
4186@item
4187global (or file-static)
4188@end itemize
4189
4190@noindent or
4191
4192@itemize @bullet
4193@item
4194visible according to the scope rules of the
4195programming language from the point of execution in that frame
4196@end itemize
4197
4198@noindent This means that in the function
4199
4200@example
4201foo (a)
4202 int a;
4203@{
4204 bar (a);
4205 @{
4206 int b = test ();
4207 bar (b);
4208 @}
4209@}
4210@end example
4211
4212@noindent
4213you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
4214executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
4215examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
4216the block where @code{b} is declared.
4217
4218@cindex variable name conflict
4219There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
4220scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
4221in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
4222function with the same name (in different source files). If that
4223happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
4224you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file,
4225using the colon-colon notation:
4226
d4f3574e 4227@cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
c906108c
SS
4228@iftex
4229@c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
4230@kindex ::
4231@end iftex
4232@example
4233@var{file}::@var{variable}
4234@var{function}::@var{variable}
4235@end example
4236
4237@noindent
4238Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
4239static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
4240make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
4241to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
4242
4243@example
4244(@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
4245@end example
4246
c906108c
SS
4247@cindex C++ scope resolution
4248This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar
4249use of the same notation in C++. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C++
4250scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
4251@c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
4252@c conflict?? --mew
c906108c
SS
4253
4254@cindex wrong values
4255@cindex variable values, wrong
4256@quotation
4257@emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
4258wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
4259scope, and just before exit.
4260@end quotation
4261You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
4262This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
4263set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
4264stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
4265values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
4266also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
4267after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
4268variable definitions may be gone.
4269
4270This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
4271To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
4272when compiling.
4273
d4f3574e
SS
4274@cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
4275Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
4276unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
4277opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
4278offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
4279might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
4280happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
4281
4282@example
4283No symbol "foo" in current context.
4284@end example
4285
4286To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
4287different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
4288formats. For example, @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C++ compiler usually
4289supports the @samp{-gstabs} option. @samp{-gstabs} produces debug info
4290in a format that is superior to formats such as COFF. You may be able
4291to use DWARF-2 (@samp{-gdwarf-2}), which is also an effective form for
4292debug info. See @ref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your
4293Program or @sc{gnu} CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}, for more
4294information.
4295
4296
53a5351d 4297@node Arrays
c906108c
SS
4298@section Artificial arrays
4299
4300@cindex artificial array
4301@kindex @@
4302It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
4303same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
4304dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
4305program.
4306
4307You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
4308@dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
4309operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
4310and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
4311of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
4312the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
4313argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
4314following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
4315example. If a program says
4316
4317@example
4318int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
4319@end example
4320
4321@noindent
4322you can print the contents of @code{array} with
4323
4324@example
4325p *array@@len
4326@end example
4327
4328The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
4329with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
4330subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
4331Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
4332(@pxref{Value History, ,Value history}), after printing one out.
4333
4334Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
4335This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
4336The value need not be in memory:
4337@example
4338(@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
4339$1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
4340@end example
4341
4342As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
d4f3574e 4343@samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) gdb calculates the size to fill
c906108c
SS
4344the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
4345@example
4346(@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
4347$2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
4348@end example
4349
4350Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
4351moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
4352actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
4353of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
4354to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4355variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
4356interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
4357instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
4358structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
4359in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
4360
4361@example
4362set $i = 0
4363p dtab[$i++]->fv
4364@key{RET}
4365@key{RET}
4366@dots{}
4367@end example
4368
53a5351d 4369@node Output Formats
c906108c
SS
4370@section Output formats
4371
4372@cindex formatted output
4373@cindex output formats
4374By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
4375this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
4376in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
4377at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
4378these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
4379
4380The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
4381already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
4382@code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
4383letters supported are:
4384
4385@table @code
4386@item x
4387Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
4388hexadecimal.
4389
4390@item d
4391Print as integer in signed decimal.
4392
4393@item u
4394Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
4395
4396@item o
4397Print as integer in octal.
4398
4399@item t
4400Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
4401@footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
4402used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
d4f3574e 4403see @ref{Memory,,Examining memory}.}
c906108c
SS
4404
4405@item a
4406@cindex unknown address, locating
4407Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
4408the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
4409where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
4410
4411@example
4412(@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
4413$3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
4414@end example
4415
4416@item c
4417Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant.
4418
4419@item f
4420Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
4421using typical floating point syntax.
4422@end table
4423
4424For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
4425
4426@example
4427p/x $pc
4428@end example
4429
4430@noindent
4431Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
4432names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
4433
4434To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
4435you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
4436expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
4437
53a5351d 4438@node Memory
c906108c
SS
4439@section Examining memory
4440
4441You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
4442any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
4443
4444@cindex examining memory
4445@table @code
4446@kindex x
4447@item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
4448@itemx x @var{addr}
4449@itemx x
4450Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
4451@end table
4452
4453@var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
4454much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
4455expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
4456If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
4457Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
4458
4459@table @r
4460@item @var{n}, the repeat count
4461The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
4462how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
4463@c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
4464@c 4.1.2.
4465
4466@item @var{f}, the display format
4467The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print},
4468@samp{s} (null-terminated string), or @samp{i} (machine instruction).
4469The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially.
4470The default changes each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
4471
4472@item @var{u}, the unit size
4473The unit size is any of
4474
4475@table @code
4476@item b
4477Bytes.
4478@item h
4479Halfwords (two bytes).
4480@item w
4481Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
4482@item g
4483Giant words (eight bytes).
4484@end table
4485
4486Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
4487default unit the next time you use @code{x}. (For the @samp{s} and
4488@samp{i} formats, the unit size is ignored and is normally not written.)
4489
4490@item @var{addr}, starting display address
4491@var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
4492memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
4493it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
4494@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
4495@var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
4496other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
4497the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
4498starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
4499a value from memory).
4500@end table
4501
4502For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
4503(@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
4504starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
4505words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
d4f3574e 4506@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
c906108c
SS
4507
4508Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
4509letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
4510unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
4511specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
4512(However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
4513
4514Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
4515and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
4516@samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
4517including any operands. The command @code{disassemble} gives an
d4f3574e 4518alternative way of inspecting machine instructions; see @ref{Machine
c906108c
SS
4519Code,,Source and machine code}.
4520
4521All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
4522easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
4523you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
4524instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
4525with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
4526the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
4527for successive uses of @code{x}.
4528
4529@cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
4530The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
4531in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
4532would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
4533subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
4534@code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
4535examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
4536@code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
4537the convenience variable @code{$__}.
4538
4539If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
4540are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
4541address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
4542
53a5351d 4543@node Auto Display
c906108c
SS
4544@section Automatic display
4545@cindex automatic display
4546@cindex display of expressions
4547
4548If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
4549(to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
4550display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
4551Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
4552to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
4553The automatic display looks like this:
4554
4555@example
45562: foo = 38
45573: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
4558@end example
4559
4560@noindent
4561This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
4562displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
4563specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
4564whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending on how elaborate your
4565format specification is---it uses @code{x} if you specify a unit size,
4566or one of the two formats (@samp{i} and @samp{s}) that are only
4567supported by @code{x}; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
4568
4569@table @code
4570@kindex display
d4f3574e
SS
4571@item display @var{expr}
4572Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
c906108c
SS
4573each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4574
4575@code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
4576
d4f3574e 4577@item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
c906108c 4578For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
d4f3574e 4579count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
c906108c
SS
4580arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
4581@xref{Output Formats,,Output formats}.
4582
4583@item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
4584For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
4585number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
4586be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
4587doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
4588@end table
4589
4590For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
4591instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
d4f3574e 4592is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
c906108c
SS
4593
4594@table @code
4595@kindex delete display
4596@kindex undisplay
4597@item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
4598@itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4599Remove item numbers @var{dnums} from the list of expressions to display.
4600
4601@code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
4602(Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
4603
4604@kindex disable display
4605@item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4606Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
4607item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
4608enabled again later.
4609
4610@kindex enable display
4611@item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4612Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
4613again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
4614
4615@item display
4616Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
4617done when your program stops.
4618
4619@kindex info display
4620@item info display
4621Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
4622automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
4623values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
4624It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
4625because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
4626@end table
4627
4628If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
4629sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
4630expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
4631variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
4632@code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
4633@code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
4634continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
4635there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
4636automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
4637is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
4638
53a5351d 4639@node Print Settings
c906108c
SS
4640@section Print settings
4641
4642@cindex format options
4643@cindex print settings
4644@value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
4645and symbols are printed.
4646
4647@noindent
4648These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
4649
4650@table @code
4651@kindex set print address
4652@item set print address
4653@itemx set print address on
4654@value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
4655traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
4656even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
4657is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
4658@code{set print address on}:
4659
4660@smallexample
4661@group
4662(@value{GDBP}) f
4663#0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
4664 at input.c:530
4665530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
4666@end group
4667@end smallexample
4668
4669@item set print address off
4670Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
4671this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
4672
4673@smallexample
4674@group
4675(@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
4676(@value{GDBP}) f
4677#0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
4678530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
4679@end group
4680@end smallexample
4681
4682You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
4683dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
4684@code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
4685all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
4686
4687@kindex show print address
4688@item show print address
4689Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
4690@end table
4691
4692When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
4693closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
4694identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
4695source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
4696@code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
4697you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
4698it prints a symbolic address:
4699
4700@table @code
4701@kindex set print symbol-filename
4702@item set print symbol-filename on
4703Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
4704symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
4705
4706@item set print symbol-filename off
4707Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
4708default.
4709
4710@kindex show print symbol-filename
4711@item show print symbol-filename
4712Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
4713line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
4714@end table
4715
4716Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
4717numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
4718number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
4719
4720Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
4721printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
4722
4723@table @code
4724@kindex set print max-symbolic-offset
4725@item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
4726Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
4727offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
4728@var{max-offset}. The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
4729to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
4730
4731@kindex show print max-symbolic-offset
4732@item show print max-symbolic-offset
4733Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
4734symbolic address.
4735@end table
4736
4737@cindex wild pointer, interpreting
4738@cindex pointer, finding referent
4739If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
4740@samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
4741and source file location of the variable where it points, using
4742@samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
4743For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
4744at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
4745
4746@example
4747(@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
4748(@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
4749$4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
4750@end example
4751
4752@quotation
4753@emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
4754does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
4755the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
4756@end quotation
4757
4758Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
4759
4760@table @code
4761@kindex set print array
4762@item set print array
4763@itemx set print array on
4764Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
4765but uses more space. The default is off.
4766
4767@item set print array off
4768Return to compressed format for arrays.
4769
4770@kindex show print array
4771@item show print array
4772Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
4773arrays.
4774
4775@kindex set print elements
4776@item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
4777Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
4778If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
4779printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
4780This limit also applies to the display of strings.
d4f3574e 4781When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
c906108c
SS
4782Setting @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
4783
4784@kindex show print elements
4785@item show print elements
4786Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
4787If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
4788
4789@kindex set print null-stop
4790@item set print null-stop
4791Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
d4f3574e 4792@sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
c906108c 4793contain only short strings.
d4f3574e 4794The default is off.
c906108c
SS
4795
4796@kindex set print pretty
4797@item set print pretty on
4798Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
4799per line, like this:
4800
4801@smallexample
4802@group
4803$1 = @{
4804 next = 0x0,
4805 flags = @{
4806 sweet = 1,
4807 sour = 1
4808 @},
4809 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
4810@}
4811@end group
4812@end smallexample
4813
4814@item set print pretty off
4815Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
4816
4817@smallexample
4818@group
4819$1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
4820meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
4821@end group
4822@end smallexample
4823
4824@noindent
4825This is the default format.
4826
4827@kindex show print pretty
4828@item show print pretty
4829Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
4830
4831@kindex set print sevenbit-strings
4832@item set print sevenbit-strings on
4833Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
4834@value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
4835character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
4836best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
4837high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
4838
4839@item set print sevenbit-strings off
4840Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
4841international character sets, and is the default.
4842
4843@kindex show print sevenbit-strings
4844@item show print sevenbit-strings
4845Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
4846
4847@kindex set print union
4848@item set print union on
4849Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures. This
4850is the default setting.
4851
4852@item set print union off
4853Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in structures.
4854
4855@kindex show print union
4856@item show print union
4857Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
4858structures.
4859
4860For example, given the declarations
4861
4862@smallexample
4863typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
4864typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
4865typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
4866 Bug_forms;
4867
4868struct thing @{
4869 Species it;
4870 union @{
4871 Tree_forms tree;
4872 Bug_forms bug;
4873 @} form;
4874@};
4875
4876struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
4877@end smallexample
4878
4879@noindent
4880with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
4881
4882@smallexample
4883$1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
4884@end smallexample
4885
4886@noindent
4887and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
4888
4889@smallexample
4890$1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
4891@end smallexample
4892@end table
4893
c906108c
SS
4894@need 1000
4895@noindent
4896These settings are of interest when debugging C++ programs:
4897
4898@table @code
4899@cindex demangling
4900@kindex set print demangle
4901@item set print demangle
4902@itemx set print demangle on
4903Print C++ names in their source form rather than in the encoded
4904(``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
d4f3574e 4905linkage. The default is on.
c906108c
SS
4906
4907@kindex show print demangle
4908@item show print demangle
4909Show whether C++ names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
4910
4911@kindex set print asm-demangle
4912@item set print asm-demangle
4913@itemx set print asm-demangle on
4914Print C++ names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
4915in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
4916The default is off.
4917
4918@kindex show print asm-demangle
4919@item show print asm-demangle
4920Show whether C++ names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
4921or demangled form.
4922
4923@kindex set demangle-style
4924@cindex C++ symbol decoding style
4925@cindex symbol decoding style, C++
4926@item set demangle-style @var{style}
4927Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
4928represent C++ names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
4929
4930@table @code
4931@item auto
4932Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
4933
4934@item gnu
4935Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C++ compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
c906108c 4936This is the default.
c906108c
SS
4937
4938@item hp
4939Decode based on the HP ANSI C++ (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
4940
4941@item lucid
4942Decode based on the Lucid C++ compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
4943
4944@item arm
4945Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C++ Annotated Reference Manual}.
4946@strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
4947debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
4948require further enhancement to permit that.
4949
4950@end table
4951If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
4952
4953@kindex show demangle-style
4954@item show demangle-style
4955Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C++ symbols.
4956
4957@kindex set print object
4958@item set print object
4959@itemx set print object on
4960When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
4961(derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
4962the virtual function table.
4963
4964@item set print object off
4965Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
4966virtual function table. This is the default setting.
4967
4968@kindex show print object
4969@item show print object
4970Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
4971
4972@kindex set print static-members
4973@item set print static-members
4974@itemx set print static-members on
4975Print static members when displaying a C++ object. The default is on.
4976
4977@item set print static-members off
4978Do not print static members when displaying a C++ object.
4979
4980@kindex show print static-members
4981@item show print static-members
4982Show whether C++ static members are printed, or not.
4983
4984@c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
4985@kindex set print vtbl
4986@item set print vtbl
4987@itemx set print vtbl on
4988Pretty print C++ virtual function tables. The default is off.
c906108c
SS
4989(The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
4990ANSI C++ compiler (@code{aCC}).)
c906108c
SS
4991
4992@item set print vtbl off
4993Do not pretty print C++ virtual function tables.
4994
4995@kindex show print vtbl
4996@item show print vtbl
4997Show whether C++ virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
4998@end table
c906108c 4999
53a5351d 5000@node Value History
c906108c
SS
5001@section Value history
5002
5003@cindex value history
5004Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
5005@dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
5006Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
5007(for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
5008When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
5009since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
5010symbol table.
5011
5012@cindex @code{$}
5013@cindex @code{$$}
5014@cindex history number
5015The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
5016refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
5017@code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
5018printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
5019history number.
5020
5021To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
5022history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
5023remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
5024the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
5025@code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
5026is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
5027@code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
5028
5029For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
5030want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
5031
5032@example
5033p *$
5034@end example
5035
5036If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
5037to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
5038
5039@example
5040p *$.next
5041@end example
5042
5043@noindent
5044You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
5045command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
5046
5047Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
5048@code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
5049
5050@example
5051print x
5052set x=5
5053@end example
5054
5055@noindent
5056then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
5057remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
5058
5059@table @code
5060@kindex show values
5061@item show values
5062Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
5063This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
5064values} does not change the history.
5065
5066@item show values @var{n}
5067Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
5068
5069@item show values +
5070Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
5071values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
5072@end table
5073
5074Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
5075same effect as @samp{show values +}.
5076
53a5351d 5077@node Convenience Vars
c906108c
SS
5078@section Convenience variables
5079
5080@cindex convenience variables
5081@value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
5082@value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
5083exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
5084setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
5085of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
5086
5087Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
5088@samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
d4f3574e 5089the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
c906108c
SS
5090(Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
5091by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value history}.)
5092
5093You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
5094expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
5095For example:
5096
5097@example
5098set $foo = *object_ptr
5099@end example
5100
5101@noindent
5102would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
5103@code{object_ptr}.
5104
5105Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
5106value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
5107value with another assignment at any time.
5108
5109Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
5110variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
5111that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
5112variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
5113
5114@table @code
5115@kindex show convenience
5116@item show convenience
5117Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values.
d4f3574e 5118Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
c906108c
SS
5119@end table
5120
5121One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
5122incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
5123a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
5124
5125@example
5126set $i = 0
5127print bar[$i++]->contents
5128@end example
5129
d4f3574e
SS
5130@noindent
5131Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
c906108c
SS
5132
5133Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
5134values likely to be useful.
5135
5136@table @code
5137@kindex $_
5138@item $_
5139The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
5140the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}). Other
5141commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
5142set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
5143and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
5144except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
5145to the type of @code{$__}.
5146
5147@kindex $__
5148@item $__
5149The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
5150to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
5151to match the format in which the data was printed.
5152
5153@item $_exitcode
5154@kindex $_exitcode
5155The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
5156the program being debugged terminates.
5157@end table
5158
53a5351d
JM
5159On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
5160begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
5161name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
c906108c 5162
53a5351d 5163@node Registers
c906108c
SS
5164@section Registers
5165
5166@cindex registers
5167You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
5168with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
5169for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
5170your machine.
5171
5172@table @code
5173@kindex info registers
5174@item info registers
5175Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
5176registers (in the selected stack frame).
5177
5178@kindex info all-registers
5179@cindex floating point registers
5180@item info all-registers
5181Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
5182registers.
5183
5184@item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
5185Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
5186As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
5187the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
5188the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
5189@end table
5190
5191@value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
5192expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
5193architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
5194@code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
5195the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
5196pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
5197register that contains the processor status. For example,
5198you could print the program counter in hex with
5199
5200@example
5201p/x $pc
5202@end example
5203
5204@noindent
5205or print the instruction to be executed next with
5206
5207@example
5208x/i $pc
5209@end example
5210
5211@noindent
5212or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
5213one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
5214memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
5215stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
5216stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
5217regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
d4f3574e 5218see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}.} with
c906108c
SS
5219
5220@example
5221set $sp += 4
5222@end example
5223
5224Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
5225your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
5226so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
5227shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
5228registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
d4f3574e
SS
5229can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
5230is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
c906108c
SS
5231
5232@value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
5233integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
5234special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
5235registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
5236to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
5237(although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
5238@samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
5239
5240Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
5241means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
5242the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
5243sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
5244coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
5245programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
5246cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
5247that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
5248prints the data in both formats.
5249
5250Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
5251(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). This means that you get the
5252value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
5253were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
5254true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
5255frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
5256
5257However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
5258code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if
5259@value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
5260frame makes no difference.
5261
53a5351d 5262@node Floating Point Hardware
c906108c
SS
5263@section Floating point hardware
5264@cindex floating point
5265
5266Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
5267you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
5268
5269@table @code
5270@kindex info float
5271@item info float
5272Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
5273point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
5274floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
5275the ARM and x86 machines.
5276@end table
c906108c 5277
53a5351d 5278@node Languages
c906108c
SS
5279@chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
5280@cindex languages
5281
c906108c
SS
5282Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
5283rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
5284dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
5285Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
5286represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
5287@samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
c906108c
SS
5288
5289@cindex working language
5290Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
5291allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
5292native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
5293consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
5294language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
5295language}.
5296
5297@menu
5298* Setting:: Switching between source languages
5299* Show:: Displaying the language
c906108c 5300* Checks:: Type and range checks
c906108c
SS
5301* Support:: Supported languages
5302@end menu
5303
53a5351d 5304@node Setting
c906108c
SS
5305@section Switching between source languages
5306
5307There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
5308set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
5309@code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
5310defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
5311used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
5312are printed, etc.
5313
5314In addition to the working language, every source file that
5315@value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
5316file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
5317source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
5318language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
5319controls whether C++ names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
5320show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
d4f3574e
SS
5321set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
5322set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
5323Displaying the language}.
c906108c
SS
5324
5325This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
5326as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
5327another language. In that case, make the
5328program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
5329@value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
5330program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
5331
5332@menu
5333* Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
5334* Manually:: Setting the working language manually
5335* Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
5336@end menu
5337
53a5351d 5338@node Filenames
c906108c
SS
5339@subsection List of filename extensions and languages
5340
5341If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
5342@value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
5343
5344@table @file
5345
5346@item .c
5347C source file
5348
5349@item .C
5350@itemx .cc
5351@itemx .cp
5352@itemx .cpp
5353@itemx .cxx
5354@itemx .c++
5355C++ source file
5356
5357@item .f
5358@itemx .F
5359Fortran source file
5360
c906108c
SS
5361@item .ch
5362@itemx .c186
5363@itemx .c286
5364CHILL source file.
c906108c 5365
c906108c
SS
5366@item .mod
5367Modula-2 source file
c906108c
SS
5368
5369@item .s
5370@itemx .S
5371Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
5372@value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
5373@end table
5374
5375In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
5376extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the language}.
5377
53a5351d 5378@node Manually
c906108c
SS
5379@subsection Setting the working language
5380
5381If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
5382expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
5383your program.
5384
5385@kindex set language
5386If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
5387command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
5388a language, such as
c906108c 5389@code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
c906108c
SS
5390For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
5391
c906108c
SS
5392Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
5393language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
5394to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
5395source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
5396languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
5397source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
5398command such as:
5399
5400@example
5401print a = b + c
5402@end example
5403
5404@noindent
5405might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
5406@code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
5407printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
5408@code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
c906108c 5409
53a5351d 5410@node Automatically
c906108c
SS
5411@subsection Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
5412
5413To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
5414@samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
5415then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
5416frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
5417working language to the language recorded for the function in that
5418frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
5419or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
5420does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
5421not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
5422
5423This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
5424entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
5425written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
5426a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
5427case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
5428
53a5351d 5429@node Show
c906108c 5430@section Displaying the language
c906108c
SS
5431
5432The following commands help you find out which language is the
5433working language, and also what language source files were written in.
5434
5435@kindex show language
d4f3574e
SS
5436@kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
5437@kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
c906108c
SS
5438@table @code
5439@item show language
5440Display the current working language. This is the
5441language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
5442build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
5443
5444@item info frame
5445Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
5446working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
5447@xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}, to identify the other
5448information listed here.
5449
5450@item info source
5451Display the source language of this source file.
5452@xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
5453information listed here.
5454@end table
5455
5456In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
5457not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
5458with a language explicitly:
5459
5460@kindex set extension-language
5461@kindex info extensions
5462@table @code
5463@item set extension-language @var{.ext} @var{language}
5464Set source files with extension @var{.ext} to be assumed to be in
5465the source language @var{language}.
5466
5467@item info extensions
5468List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
5469@end table
5470
53a5351d 5471@node Checks
c906108c
SS
5472@section Type and range checking
5473
5474@quotation
5475@emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range
5476checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect. This
5477section documents the intended facilities.
5478@end quotation
5479@c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added
5480
5481Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
5482errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
5483checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making
5484sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
5485these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
5486by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range
5487errors when your program is running.
5488
5489@value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish.
5490Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program, it
5491can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via
5492the @code{print} command, for example. As with the working language,
5493@value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check automatically based on
5494your program's source language. @xref{Support, ,Supported languages},
5495for the default settings of supported languages.
5496
5497@menu
5498* Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
5499* Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
5500@end menu
5501
5502@cindex type checking
5503@cindex checks, type
53a5351d 5504@node Type Checking
c906108c
SS
5505@subsection An overview of type checking
5506
5507Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the
5508arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
5509otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
5510errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
5511
5512@smallexample
55131 + 2 @result{} 3
5514@exdent but
5515@error{} 1 + 2.3
5516@end smallexample
5517
5518The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not
5519type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3.
5520
5521For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the
5522@value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking;
5523to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
5524or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur,
5525but evaluate the expression anyway. When you choose the last of
5526these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but
5527also issues a warning.
5528
5529Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons
5530related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
5531For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
5532a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
5533with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as
5534the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
5535
5536Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type. For
5537instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical
5538operators to be numbers. In C, enumerated types and pointers can be
5539represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical
5540operators. @xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for further
5541details on specific languages.
5542
5543@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker:
5544
d4f3574e 5545@kindex set check@r{, type}
c906108c
SS
5546@kindex set check type
5547@kindex show check type
5548@table @code
5549@item set check type auto
5550Set type checking on or off based on the current working language.
5551@xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
5552each language.
5553
5554@item set check type on
5555@itemx set check type off
5556Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
5557current working language. Issue a warning if the setting does not
5558match the language default. If any type mismatches occur in
d4f3574e 5559evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
c906108c
SS
5560message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
5561
5562@item set check type warn
5563Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to
5564evaluate the expression. Evaluating the expression may still
5565be impossible for other reasons. For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add
5566numbers and structures.
5567
5568@item show type
5569Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN}
5570is setting it automatically.
5571@end table
5572
5573@cindex range checking
5574@cindex checks, range
53a5351d 5575@node Range Checking
c906108c
SS
5576@subsection An overview of range checking
5577
5578In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
5579bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
5580checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
5581computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
5582not exceed the bounds of the array.
5583
5584For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
5585@value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
5586always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
5587warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
5588
5589A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
5590array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
5591of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
5592error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
5593result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
5594the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
5595
5596@example
5597@var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
5598@end example
5599
5600This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
5601specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Support, ,
5602Supported languages}, for further details on specific languages.
5603
5604@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
5605
d4f3574e 5606@kindex set check@r{, range}
c906108c
SS
5607@kindex set check range
5608@kindex show check range
5609@table @code
5610@item set check range auto
5611Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
5612@xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
5613each language.
5614
5615@item set check range on
5616@itemx set check range off
5617Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
5618current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
5619match the language default. If a range error occurs, then a message
5620is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
5621
5622@item set check range warn
5623Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
5624but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
5625expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
5626memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
5627systems).
5628
5629@item show range
5630Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
5631being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
5632@end table
c906108c 5633
53a5351d 5634@node Support
c906108c 5635@section Supported languages
c906108c 5636
cce74817
JM
5637@value{GDBN} supports C, C++, Fortran, Java, Chill, assembly, and Modula-2.
5638@c This is false ...
c906108c
SS
5639Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
5640language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
5641and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
5642,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
5643language.
5644
5645The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
5646supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
5647tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
5648@value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
5649formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
5650books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
5651language reference or tutorial.
5652
c906108c 5653@menu
7a292a7a 5654* C:: C and C++
cce74817 5655* Modula-2:: Modula-2
104c1213 5656* Chill:: Chill
c906108c
SS
5657@end menu
5658
53a5351d 5659@node C
c906108c 5660@subsection C and C++
7a292a7a 5661
c906108c
SS
5662@cindex C and C++
5663@cindex expressions in C or C++
c906108c
SS
5664
5665Since C and C++ are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
5666to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
5667together.
5668
c906108c
SS
5669@cindex C++
5670@kindex g++
5671@cindex @sc{gnu} C++
5672The C++ debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C++
5673compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C++ code
5674effectively, you must compile your C++ programs with a supported
5675C++ compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C++
5676compiler (@code{aCC}).
5677
5678For best results when using @sc{gnu} C++, use the stabs debugging
5679format. You can select that format explicitly with the @code{g++}
5680command-line options @samp{-gstabs} or @samp{-gstabs+}. See
5681@ref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or @sc{gnu}
5682CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}, for more information.
c906108c 5683
c906108c
SS
5684@menu
5685* C Operators:: C and C++ operators
5686* C Constants:: C and C++ constants
7a292a7a 5687* C plus plus expressions:: C++ expressions
c906108c 5688* C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C++
c906108c 5689* C Checks:: C and C++ type and range checks
c906108c
SS
5690* Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
5691* Debugging C plus plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C++
5692@end menu
c906108c 5693
53a5351d 5694@node C Operators
c906108c 5695@subsubsection C and C++ operators
7a292a7a
SS
5696
5697@cindex C and C++ operators
c906108c
SS
5698
5699Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
5700@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
5701often defined on groups of types.
5702
c906108c 5703For the purposes of C and C++, the following definitions hold:
c906108c
SS
5704
5705@itemize @bullet
53a5351d 5706
c906108c 5707@item
c906108c
SS
5708@emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
5709specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C++, @code{bool}.
c906108c
SS
5710
5711@item
d4f3574e
SS
5712@emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
5713@code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
c906108c
SS
5714
5715@item
53a5351d 5716@emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
c906108c
SS
5717
5718@item
5719@emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
53a5351d 5720
c906108c
SS
5721@end itemize
5722
5723@noindent
5724The following operators are supported. They are listed here
5725in order of increasing precedence:
5726
5727@table @code
5728@item ,
5729The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
5730are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
5731expression being the last expression evaluated.
5732
5733@item =
5734Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
5735assigned. Defined on scalar types.
5736
5737@item @var{op}=
5738Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
5739and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
d4f3574e 5740@w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
c906108c
SS
5741@var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
5742@code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
5743
5744@item ?:
5745The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
5746of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
5747integral type.
5748
5749@item ||
5750Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
5751
5752@item &&
5753Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
5754
5755@item |
5756Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
5757
5758@item ^
5759Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
5760
5761@item &
5762Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
5763
5764@item ==@r{, }!=
5765Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
5766expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
5767
5768@item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
5769Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
5770Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
5771and non-zero for true.
5772
5773@item <<@r{, }>>
5774left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
5775
5776@item @@
5777The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
5778
5779@item +@r{, }-
5780Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
5781pointer types.
5782
5783@item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
5784Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
5785defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
5786integral types.
5787
5788@item ++@r{, }--
5789Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
5790operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
5791when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
5792operation takes place.
5793
5794@item *
5795Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
5796@code{++}.
5797
5798@item &
5799Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
5800
c906108c
SS
5801For debugging C++, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
5802allowed in the C++ language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
5803(or, if you prefer, simply @samp{&&@var{ref}}) to examine the address
5804where a C++ reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
5805stored.
c906108c
SS
5806
5807@item -
5808Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
5809precedence as @code{++}.
5810
5811@item !
5812Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
5813@code{++}.
5814
5815@item ~
5816Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
5817@code{++}.
5818
5819
5820@item .@r{, }->
5821Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
5822@value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
5823pointer based on the stored type information.
5824Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
5825
c906108c
SS
5826@item .*@r{, }->*
5827Dereferences of pointers to members.
c906108c
SS
5828
5829@item []
5830Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
5831@code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
5832
5833@item ()
5834Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
5835
c906108c 5836@item ::
7a292a7a
SS
5837C++ scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
5838and @code{class} types.
c906108c
SS
5839
5840@item ::
7a292a7a
SS
5841Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
5842(@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
5843above.
c906108c
SS
5844@end table
5845
c906108c
SS
5846If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
5847attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
5848predefined meaning.
c906108c 5849
c906108c
SS
5850@menu
5851* C Constants::
5852@end menu
5853
53a5351d 5854@node C Constants
c906108c 5855@subsubsection C and C++ constants
c906108c
SS
5856
5857@cindex C and C++ constants
c906108c 5858
7a292a7a 5859@value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C++ in the
c906108c 5860following ways:
c906108c
SS
5861
5862@itemize @bullet
5863@item
5864Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
5865specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e. zero), and hexadecimal constants by
5866a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
5867@samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
5868@code{long} value.
5869
5870@item
5871Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
5872point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
5873exponent. An exponent is of the form:
5874@samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
5875sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
d4f3574e
SS
5876A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
5877@samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
5878the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
5879a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
5880constant.
c906108c
SS
5881
5882@item
5883Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
5884integral equivalents.
5885
5886@item
5887Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
5888(@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
d4f3574e 5889(usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
c906108c
SS
5890be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
5891the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
5892of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
5893@samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
5894@samp{\n} for newline.
5895
5896@item
5897String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded
5898by double quotes (@code{"}).
5899
5900@item
5901Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
5902to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
5903
5904@item
5905Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
5906and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
5907integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
5908and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
5909@end itemize
5910
c906108c 5911@menu
7a292a7a 5912* C plus plus expressions::
c906108c 5913* C Defaults::
c906108c 5914* C Checks::
c906108c
SS
5915
5916* Debugging C::
5917@end menu
5918
53a5351d 5919@node C plus plus expressions
c906108c 5920@subsubsection C++ expressions
c906108c
SS
5921
5922@cindex expressions in C++
5923@value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C++ expressions.
5924
c906108c
SS
5925@cindex C++ support, not in @sc{coff}
5926@cindex @sc{coff} versus C++
5927@cindex C++ and object formats
5928@cindex object formats and C++
5929@cindex a.out and C++
5930@cindex @sc{ecoff} and C++
5931@cindex @sc{xcoff} and C++
5932@cindex @sc{elf}/stabs and C++
5933@cindex @sc{elf}/@sc{dwarf} and C++
5934@c FIXME!! GDB may eventually be able to debug C++ using DWARF; check
5935@c periodically whether this has happened...
5936@quotation
5937@emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C++ code if you use the
5938proper compiler. Typically, C++ debugging depends on the use of
5939additional debugging information in the symbol table, and thus requires
5940special support. In particular, if your compiler generates a.out, MIPS
5941@sc{ecoff}, RS/6000 @sc{xcoff}, or @sc{elf} with stabs extensions to the
5942symbol table, these facilities are all available. (With @sc{gnu} CC,
5943you can use the @samp{-gstabs} option to request stabs debugging
5944extensions explicitly.) Where the object code format is standard
5945@sc{coff} or @sc{dwarf} in @sc{elf}, on the other hand, most of the C++
5946support in @value{GDBN} does @emph{not} work.
5947@end quotation
c906108c
SS
5948
5949@enumerate
5950
5951@cindex member functions
5952@item
5953Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
5954
5955@example
5956count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
5957@end example
5958
5959@kindex this
5960@cindex namespace in C++
5961@item
5962While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
5963expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
5964that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
5965pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C++.
5966
c906108c 5967@cindex call overloaded functions
d4f3574e 5968@cindex overloaded functions, calling
c906108c
SS
5969@cindex type conversions in C++
5970@item
5971You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
d4f3574e 5972call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
c906108c
SS
5973perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
5974calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
5975in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
5976default arguments.
5977
5978It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
5979promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
5980class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
5981functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
5982number of function arguments.
5983
5984Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
5985@code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C plus plus,
5986,@value{GDBN} features for C++}.
5987
d4f3574e 5988You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
c906108c
SS
5989explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
5990@smallexample
5991p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
5992@end smallexample
d4f3574e 5993
c906108c 5994The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
d4f3574e 5995see @ref{Completion, ,Command completion}.
c906108c 5996
c906108c
SS
5997@cindex reference declarations
5998@item
5999@value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C++ references; you can use
6000them in expressions just as you do in C++ source---they are automatically
6001dereferenced.
6002
6003In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
6004reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
6005avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
6006The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
6007you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
6008
6009@item
6010@value{GDBN} supports the C++ name resolution operator @code{::}---your
6011expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
6012one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
6013necessary, for example in an expression like
6014@samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
6015resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C++
6016debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program variables}).
6017@end enumerate
6018
53a5351d
JM
6019In addition, when used with HP's C++ compiler, @value{GDBN} supports
6020calling virtual functions correctly, printing out virtual bases of
6021objects, calling functions in a base subobject, casting objects, and
6022invoking user-defined operators.
c906108c 6023
53a5351d 6024@node C Defaults
c906108c 6025@subsubsection C and C++ defaults
7a292a7a 6026
c906108c
SS
6027@cindex C and C++ defaults
6028
c906108c
SS
6029If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they
6030both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
6031C or C++. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
6032selects the working language.
c906108c
SS
6033
6034If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
6035recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
6036@file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
6037these files, it sets the working language to C or C++.
6038@xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language},
6039for further details.
6040
c906108c
SS
6041@c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b)
6042@c unimplemented. If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node
6043@c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93.
7a292a7a 6044
53a5351d 6045@node C Checks
c906108c 6046@subsubsection C and C++ type and range checks
7a292a7a 6047
c906108c
SS
6048@cindex C and C++ checks
6049
6050By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C++ expressions, type checking
6051is not used. However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN}
6052considers two variables type equivalent if:
6053
6054@itemize @bullet
6055@item
6056The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or
6057enumerated tag.
6058
6059@item
6060The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been
6061declared equivalent through @code{typedef}.
6062
6063@ignore
6064@c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it.
6065@c FIXME--beers?
6066@item
6067The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are
6068declared in the same declaration. (Note: this may not be true for all C
6069compilers.)
6070@end ignore
6071@end itemize
6072
6073Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
6074indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
6075that is not itself an array.
c906108c 6076
53a5351d 6077@node Debugging C
c906108c 6078@subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
c906108c
SS
6079
6080The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
6081the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
7a292a7a
SS
6082inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
6083appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
c906108c
SS
6084
6085The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
6086with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
6087,Expressions}.
6088
c906108c
SS
6089@menu
6090* Debugging C plus plus::
6091@end menu
6092
53a5351d 6093@node Debugging C plus plus
c906108c 6094@subsubsection @value{GDBN} features for C++
c906108c
SS
6095
6096@cindex commands for C++
7a292a7a 6097
c906108c
SS
6098Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C++, and some are
6099designed specifically for use with C++. Here is a summary:
6100
6101@table @code
6102@cindex break in overloaded functions
6103@item @r{breakpoint menus}
6104When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
6105@value{GDBN} breakpoint menus help you specify which function definition
6106you want. @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}.
6107
6108@cindex overloading in C++
6109@item rbreak @var{regex}
6110Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
6111breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
6112classes.
6113@xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}.
6114
6115@cindex C++ exception handling
6116@item catch throw
6117@itemx catch catch
6118Debug C++ exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
6119Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
6120
6121@cindex inheritance
6122@item ptype @var{typename}
6123Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
6124@var{typename}.
6125@xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
6126
6127@cindex C++ symbol display
6128@item set print demangle
6129@itemx show print demangle
6130@itemx set print asm-demangle
6131@itemx show print asm-demangle
6132Control whether C++ symbols display in their source form, both when
6133displaying code as C++ source and when displaying disassemblies.
6134@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
6135
6136@item set print object
6137@itemx show print object
6138Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
6139@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
6140
6141@item set print vtbl
6142@itemx show print vtbl
6143Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
6144@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
c906108c
SS
6145(The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
6146ANSI C++ compiler (@code{aCC}).)
6147
6148@kindex set overload-resolution
d4f3574e 6149@cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
c906108c
SS
6150@item set overload-resolution on
6151Enable overload resolution for C++ expression evaluation. The default
6152is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
6153and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
d4f3574e
SS
6154using the standard C++ conversion rules (see @ref{C plus plus expressions, ,C++
6155expressions}, for details). If it cannot find a match, it emits a
c906108c
SS
6156message.
6157
6158@item set overload-resolution off
6159Disable overload resolution for C++ expression evaluation. For
6160overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
6161chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
6162symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
6163overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
6164searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
6165argument types.
c906108c
SS
6166
6167@item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
6168You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
6169the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C++: type
6170@code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
6171also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
6172available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
6173@xref{Completion,, Command completion}, for details on how to do this.
6174@end table
c906108c 6175
53a5351d 6176@node Modula-2
c906108c 6177@subsection Modula-2
7a292a7a 6178
d4f3574e 6179@cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
c906108c
SS
6180
6181The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
6182output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
6183developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
6184attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
6185to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
6186table.
6187
6188@cindex expressions in Modula-2
6189@menu
6190* M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
6191* Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
6192* M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
6193* M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
6194* Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
6195* M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
6196* M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
6197* GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
6198@end menu
6199
53a5351d 6200@node M2 Operators
c906108c
SS
6201@subsubsection Operators
6202@cindex Modula-2 operators
6203
6204Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
6205@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
6206often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
6207following definitions hold:
6208
6209@itemize @bullet
6210
6211@item
6212@emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
6213their subranges.
6214
6215@item
6216@emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
6217
6218@item
6219@emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
6220
6221@item
6222@emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
6223@var{type}}.
6224
6225@item
6226@emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
6227
6228@item
6229@emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
6230
6231@item
6232@emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
6233@end itemize
6234
6235@noindent
6236The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
6237increasing precedence:
6238
6239@table @code
6240@item ,
6241Function argument or array index separator.
6242
6243@item :=
6244Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
6245@var{value}.
6246
6247@item <@r{, }>
6248Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
6249types.
6250
6251@item <=@r{, }>=
6252Less than, greater than, less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
6253on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
6254set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
6255
6256@item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
6257Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
6258Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
6259available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
6260comment character.
6261
6262@item IN
6263Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
6264Same precedence as @code{<}.
6265
6266@item OR
6267Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
6268
6269@item AND@r{, }&
d4f3574e 6270Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
c906108c
SS
6271
6272@item @@
6273The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
6274
6275@item +@r{, }-
6276Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
6277and difference on set types.
6278
6279@item *
6280Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
6281on set types.
6282
6283@item /
6284Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
6285types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
6286
6287@item DIV@r{, }MOD
6288Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
6289precedence as @code{*}.
6290
6291@item -
6292Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
6293
6294@item ^
6295Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
6296
6297@item NOT
6298Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
6299@code{^}.
6300
6301@item .
6302@code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
6303precedence as @code{^}.
6304
6305@item []
6306Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
6307
6308@item ()
6309Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
6310as @code{^}.
6311
6312@item ::@r{, }.
6313@value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
6314@end table
6315
6316@quotation
6317@emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
6318treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
6319@code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
6320@code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
6321@end quotation
6322
6323@cindex Modula-2 built-ins
53a5351d 6324@node Built-In Func/Proc
c906108c
SS
6325@subsubsection Built-in functions and procedures
6326
6327Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
6328In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
6329
6330@table @var
6331
6332@item a
6333represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
6334
6335@item c
6336represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
6337
6338@item i
6339represents a variable or constant of integral type.
6340
6341@item m
6342represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
6343same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
6344be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
6345
6346@item n
6347represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
6348
6349@item r
6350represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
6351
6352@item t
6353represents a type.
6354
6355@item v
6356represents a variable.
6357
6358@item x
6359represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
6360explanation of the function for details.
6361@end table
6362
6363All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
6364
6365@table @code
6366@item ABS(@var{n})
6367Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
6368
6369@item CAP(@var{c})
6370If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
6371equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument
6372
6373@item CHR(@var{i})
6374Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
6375
6376@item DEC(@var{v})
6377Decrements the value in the variable @var{v}. Returns the new value.
6378
6379@item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
6380Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
6381new value.
6382
6383@item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
6384Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
6385set.
6386
6387@item FLOAT(@var{i})
6388Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
6389
6390@item HIGH(@var{a})
6391Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
6392
6393@item INC(@var{v})
6394Increments the value in the variable @var{v}. Returns the new value.
6395
6396@item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
6397Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
6398new value.
6399
6400@item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
6401Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
6402there. Returns the new set.
6403
6404@item MAX(@var{t})
6405Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
6406
6407@item MIN(@var{t})
6408Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
6409
6410@item ODD(@var{i})
6411Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
6412
6413@item ORD(@var{x})
6414Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
6415value of a character is its ASCII value (on machines supporting the
6416ASCII character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
6417integral, character and enumerated types.
6418
6419@item SIZE(@var{x})
6420Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
6421
6422@item TRUNC(@var{r})
6423Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
6424
6425@item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
6426Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
6427@end table
6428
6429@quotation
6430@emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
6431@value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
6432an error.
6433@end quotation
6434
6435@cindex Modula-2 constants
53a5351d 6436@node M2 Constants
c906108c
SS
6437@subsubsection Constants
6438
6439@value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
6440ways:
6441
6442@itemize @bullet
6443
6444@item
6445Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
6446expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
6447rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
6448trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
6449
6450@item
6451Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
6452decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
6453then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
6454@samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
6455digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
6456digits.
6457
6458@item
6459Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
6460like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
6461also be expressed by their ordinal value (their ASCII value, usually)
6462followed by a @samp{C}.
6463
6464@item
6465String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
6466pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
6467Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
6468Constants, ,C and C++ constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
6469sequences.
6470
6471@item
6472Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
6473
6474@item
6475Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
6476@code{FALSE}.
6477
6478@item
6479Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
6480
6481@item
6482Set constants are not yet supported.
6483@end itemize
6484
53a5351d 6485@node M2 Defaults
c906108c
SS
6486@subsubsection Modula-2 defaults
6487@cindex Modula-2 defaults
6488
6489If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
6490both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
d4f3574e 6491Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
6492selected the working language.
6493
6494If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
6495code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
d4f3574e 6496working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} set
c906108c
SS
6497the language automatically}, for further details.
6498
53a5351d 6499@node Deviations
c906108c
SS
6500@subsubsection Deviations from standard Modula-2
6501@cindex Modula-2, deviations from
6502
6503A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
6504This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
6505
6506@itemize @bullet
6507@item
6508Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
6509integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
6510debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
6511pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
6512through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
6513returned a pointer.)
6514
6515@item
6516C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
6517non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
6518escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
6519printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
6520
6521@item
6522The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
6523argument.
6524
6525@item
6526All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
6527@end itemize
6528
53a5351d 6529@node M2 Checks
c906108c
SS
6530@subsubsection Modula-2 type and range checks
6531@cindex Modula-2 checks
6532
6533@quotation
6534@emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
6535range checking.
6536@end quotation
6537@c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
6538
6539@value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
6540
6541@itemize @bullet
6542@item
6543They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
6544@var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
6545
6546@item
6547They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
6548@sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
6549@end itemize
6550
6551As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
6552whose types are not equivalent is an error.
6553
6554Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
6555index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
6556
53a5351d 6557@node M2 Scope
c906108c
SS
6558@subsubsection The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
6559@cindex scope
6560@kindex .
6561@cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
6562@ifinfo
d4f3574e 6563@kindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
c906108c
SS
6564@c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
6565@end ifinfo
6566@iftex
6567@kindex ::
6568@end iftex
6569
6570There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
6571(@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
6572similar syntax:
6573
6574@example
6575
6576@var{module} . @var{id}
6577@var{scope} :: @var{id}
6578@end example
6579
6580@noindent
6581where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
6582@var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
6583identifier within your program, except another module.
6584
6585Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
6586specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
6587found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
6588enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
6589
6590Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
6591the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
6592definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
6593an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
6594module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
6595@var{module}.
6596
53a5351d 6597@node GDB/M2
c906108c
SS
6598@subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
6599
6600Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
6601Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
6602specifically to C and C++: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
6603@samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
6604apply to C++, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
6605analogue in Modula-2.
6606
6607The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
d4f3574e 6608with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
c906108c
SS
6609intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
6610created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C++. However, because an
6611address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
d4f3574e 6612@samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
c906108c
SS
6613
6614@cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
6615In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
6616interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
c906108c 6617
53a5351d 6618@node Chill
cce74817
JM
6619@subsection Chill
6620
6621The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Chill only support output
d4f3574e 6622from the @sc{gnu} Chill compiler. Other Chill compilers are not currently
cce74817
JM
6623supported, and attempting to debug executables produced by them is most
6624likely to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
6625table.
6626
d4f3574e
SS
6627@c This used to say "... following Chill related topics ...", but since
6628@c menus are not shown in the printed manual, it would look awkward.
6629This section covers the Chill related topics and the features
cce74817
JM
6630of @value{GDBN} which support these topics.
6631
6632@menu
104c1213
JM
6633* How modes are displayed:: How modes are displayed
6634* Locations:: Locations and their accesses
cce74817 6635* Values and their Operations:: Values and their Operations
53a5351d
JM
6636* Chill type and range checks::
6637* Chill defaults::
cce74817
JM
6638@end menu
6639
6640@node How modes are displayed
6641@subsubsection How modes are displayed
6642
6643The Chill Datatype- (Mode) support of @value{GDBN} is directly related
d4f3574e 6644with the functionality of the @sc{gnu} Chill compiler, and therefore deviates
cce74817
JM
6645slightly from the standard specification of the Chill language. The
6646provided modes are:
d4f3574e
SS
6647
6648@c FIXME: this @table's contents effectively disable @code by using @r
6649@c on every @item. So why does it need @code?
cce74817
JM
6650@table @code
6651@item @r{@emph{Discrete modes:}}
6652@itemize @bullet
6653@item
6654@emph{Integer Modes} which are predefined by @code{BYTE, UBYTE, INT,
6655UINT, LONG, ULONG},
6656@item
6657@emph{Boolean Mode} which is predefined by @code{BOOL},
6658@item
6659@emph{Character Mode} which is predefined by @code{CHAR},
6660@item
6661@emph{Set Mode} which is displayed by the keyword @code{SET}.
6662@smallexample
6663(@value{GDBP}) ptype x
6664type = SET (karli = 10, susi = 20, fritzi = 100)
6665@end smallexample
6666If the type is an unnumbered set the set element values are omitted.
6667@item
6668@emph{Range Mode} which is displayed by @code{type = <basemode>
6669(<lower bound> : <upper bound>)}, where @code{<lower bound>, <upper
6670bound>} can be of any discrete literal expression (e.g. set element
6671names).
6672@end itemize
6673
6674@item @r{@emph{Powerset Mode:}}
6675A Powerset Mode is displayed by the keyword @code{POWERSET} followed by
d4f3574e 6676the member mode of the powerset. The member mode can be any discrete mode.
cce74817
JM
6677@smallexample
6678(@value{GDBP}) ptype x
6679type = POWERSET SET (egon, hugo, otto)
6680@end smallexample
6681
6682@item @r{@emph{Reference Modes:}}
6683@itemize @bullet
6684@item
d4f3574e 6685@emph{Bound Reference Mode} which is displayed by the keyword @code{REF}
cce74817
JM
6686followed by the mode name to which the reference is bound.
6687@item
6688@emph{Free Reference Mode} which is displayed by the keyword @code{PTR}.
6689@end itemize
6690
6691@item @r{@emph{Procedure mode}}
6692The procedure mode is displayed by @code{type = PROC(<parameter list>)
6693<return mode> EXCEPTIONS (<exception list>)}. The @code{<parameter
d4f3574e
SS
6694list>} is a list of the parameter modes. @code{<return mode>} indicates
6695the mode of the result of the procedure if any. The exceptionlist lists
cce74817
JM
6696all possible exceptions which can be raised by the procedure.
6697
6698@ignore
6699@item @r{@emph{Instance mode}}
6700The instance mode is represented by a structure, which has a static
6701type, and is therefore not really of interest.
6702@end ignore
6703
6704@item @r{@emph{Synchronization Modes:}}
6705@itemize @bullet
6706@item
6707@emph{Event Mode} which is displayed by @code{EVENT (<event length>)},
6708where @code{(<event length>)} is optional.
6709@item
6710@emph{Buffer Mode} which is displayed by @code{BUFFER (<buffer length>)
6711<buffer element mode>}, where @code{(<buffer length>)} is optional.
6712@end itemize
6713
6714@item @r{@emph{Timing Modes:}}
6715@itemize @bullet
6716@item
6717@emph{Duration Mode} which is predefined by @code{DURATION}
6718@item
6719@emph{Absolute Time Mode} which is predefined by @code{TIME}
6720@end itemize
6721
6722@item @r{@emph{Real Modes:}}
6723Real Modes are predefined with @code{REAL} and @code{LONG_REAL}.
6724
6725@item @r{@emph{String Modes:}}
6726@itemize @bullet
6727@item
6728@emph{Character String Mode} which is displayed by @code{CHARS(<string
6729length>)}, followed by the keyword @code{VARYING} if the String Mode is
6730a varying mode
6731@item
6732@emph{Bit String Mode} which is displayed by @code{BOOLS(<string
6733length>)}.
6734@end itemize
6735
6736@item @r{@emph{Array Mode:}}
6737The Array Mode is displayed by the keyword @code{ARRAY(<range>)}
6738followed by the element mode (which may in turn be an array mode).
6739@smallexample
6740(@value{GDBP}) ptype x
6741type = ARRAY (1:42)
6742 ARRAY (1:20)
6743 SET (karli = 10, susi = 20, fritzi = 100)
6744@end smallexample
6745
6746@item @r{@emph{Structure Mode}}
6747The Structure mode is displayed by the keyword @code{STRUCT(<field
d4f3574e
SS
6748list>)}. The @code{<field list>} consists of names and modes of fields
6749of the structure. Variant structures have the keyword @code{CASE <field>
6750OF <variant fields> ESAC} in their field list. Since the current version
cce74817
JM
6751of the GNU Chill compiler doesn't implement tag processing (no runtime
6752checks of variant fields, and therefore no debugging info), the output
6753always displays all variant fields.
6754@smallexample
6755(@value{GDBP}) ptype str
6756type = STRUCT (
6757 as x,
6758 bs x,
6759 CASE bs OF
6760 (karli):
6761 cs a
6762 (ott):
6763 ds x
6764 ESAC
6765)
6766@end smallexample
6767@end table
6768
6769@node Locations
6770@subsubsection Locations and their accesses
6771
6772A location in Chill is an object which can contain values.
6773
6774A value of a location is generally accessed by the (declared) name of
d4f3574e
SS
6775the location. The output conforms to the specification of values in
6776Chill programs. How values are specified
6777is the topic of the next section, @ref{Values and their Operations}.
cce74817
JM
6778
6779The pseudo-location @code{RESULT} (or @code{result}) can be used to
6780display or change the result of a currently-active procedure:
d4f3574e 6781
cce74817
JM
6782@smallexample
6783set result := EXPR
6784@end smallexample
d4f3574e
SS
6785
6786@noindent
6787This does the same as the Chill action @code{RESULT EXPR} (which
cce74817
JM
6788is not available in gdb).
6789
6790Values of reference mode locations are printed by @code{PTR(<hex
6791value>)} in case of a free reference mode, and by @code{(REF <reference
d4f3574e 6792mode>) (<hex-value>)} in case of a bound reference. @code{<hex value>}
cce74817
JM
6793represents the address where the reference points to. To access the
6794value of the location referenced by the pointer, use the dereference
d4f3574e 6795operator @samp{->}.
cce74817
JM
6796
6797Values of procedure mode locations are displayed by @code{@{ PROC
6798(<argument modes> ) <return mode> @} <address> <name of procedure
d4f3574e 6799location>}. @code{<argument modes>} is a list of modes according to the
cce74817
JM
6800parameter specification of the procedure and @code{<address>} shows the
6801address of the entry point.
6802
6803@ignore
6804Locations of instance modes are displayed just like a structure with two
6805fields specifying the @emph{process type} and the @emph{copy number} of
6806the investigated instance location@footnote{This comes from the current
d4f3574e
SS
6807implementation of instances. They are implemented as a structure (no
6808na). The output should be something like @code{[<name of the process>;
6809<instance number>]}.}. The field names are @code{__proc_type} and
cce74817
JM
6810@code{__proc_copy}.
6811
6812Locations of synchronization modes are displayed like a structure with
6813the field name @code{__event_data} in case of a event mode location, and
6814like a structure with the field @code{__buffer_data} in case of a buffer
6815mode location (refer to previous paragraph).
6816
6817Structure Mode locations are printed by @code{[.<field name>: <value>,
d4f3574e 6818...]}. The @code{<field name>} corresponds to the structure mode
cce74817 6819definition and the layout of @code{<value>} varies depending of the mode
d4f3574e
SS
6820of the field. If the investigated structure mode location is of variant
6821structure mode, the variant parts of the structure are enclosed in curled
6822braces (@samp{@{@}}). Fields enclosed by @samp{@{,@}} are residing
cce74817 6823on the same memory location and represent the current values of the
d4f3574e 6824memory location in their specific modes. Since no tag processing is done
cce74817 6825all variants are displayed. A variant field is printed by
d4f3574e 6826@code{(<variant name>) = .<field name>: <value>}. (who implements the
cce74817
JM
6827stuff ???)
6828@smallexample
6829(@value{GDBP}) print str1 $4 = [.as: 0, .bs: karli, .<TAG>: { (karli) =
6830[.cs: []], (susi) = [.ds: susi]}]
6831@end smallexample
6832@end ignore
6833
6834Substructures of string mode-, array mode- or structure mode-values
6835(e.g. array slices, fields of structure locations) are accessed using
d4f3574e
SS
6836certain operations which are described in the next section, @ref{Values
6837and their Operations}.
cce74817
JM
6838
6839A location value may be interpreted as having a different mode using the
d4f3574e
SS
6840location conversion. This mode conversion is written as @code{<mode
6841name>(<location>)}. The user has to consider that the sizes of the modes
6842have to be equal otherwise an error occurs. Furthermore, no range
6843checking of the location against the destination mode is performed, and
cce74817 6844therefore the result can be quite confusing.
d4f3574e 6845
cce74817
JM
6846@smallexample
6847(@value{GDBP}) print int (s(3 up 4)) XXX TO be filled in !! XXX
6848@end smallexample
6849
6850@node Values and their Operations
6851@subsubsection Values and their Operations
6852
6853Values are used to alter locations, to investigate complex structures in
6854more detail or to filter relevant information out of a large amount of
d4f3574e
SS
6855data. There are several (mode dependent) operations defined which enable
6856such investigations. These operations are not only applicable to
cce74817 6857constant values but also to locations, which can become quite useful
d4f3574e 6858when debugging complex structures. During parsing the command line
cce74817
JM
6859(e.g. evaluating an expression) @value{GDBN} treats location names as
6860the values behind these locations.
6861
d4f3574e 6862This section describes how values have to be specified and which
cce74817
JM
6863operations are legal to be used with such values.
6864
6865@table @code
6866@item Literal Values
d4f3574e
SS
6867Literal values are specified in the same manner as in @sc{gnu} Chill programs.
6868For detailed specification refer to the @sc{gnu} Chill implementation Manual
cce74817 6869chapter 1.5.
d4f3574e
SS
6870@c FIXME: if the Chill Manual is a Texinfo documents, the above should
6871@c be converted to a @ref.
cce74817
JM
6872
6873@ignore
6874@itemize @bullet
6875@item
6876@emph{Integer Literals} are specified in the same manner as in Chill
d4f3574e 6877programs (refer to the Chill Standard z200/88 chpt 5.2.4.2)
cce74817
JM
6878@item
6879@emph{Boolean Literals} are defined by @code{TRUE} and @code{FALSE}.
6880@item
6881@emph{Character Literals} are defined by @code{'<character>'}. (e.g.
6882@code{'M'})
6883@item
6884@emph{Set Literals} are defined by a name which was specified in a set
d4f3574e
SS
6885mode. The value delivered by a Set Literal is the set value. This is
6886comparable to an enumeration in C/C++ language.
cce74817 6887@item
d4f3574e 6888@emph{Emptiness Literal} is predefined by @code{NULL}. The value of the
cce74817
JM
6889emptiness literal delivers either the empty reference value, the empty
6890procedure value or the empty instance value.
6891
6892@item
6893@emph{Character String Literals} are defined by a sequence of characters
d4f3574e 6894enclosed in single- or double quotes. If a single- or double quote has
cce74817
JM
6895to be part of the string literal it has to be stuffed (specified twice).
6896@item
6897@emph{Bitstring Literals} are specified in the same manner as in Chill
6898programs (refer z200/88 chpt 5.2.4.8).
6899@item
6900@emph{Floating point literals} are specified in the same manner as in
d4f3574e 6901(gnu-)Chill programs (refer @sc{gnu} Chill implementation Manual chapter 1.5).
cce74817
JM
6902@end itemize
6903@end ignore
6904
6905@item Tuple Values
6906A tuple is specified by @code{<mode name>[<tuple>]}, where @code{<mode
d4f3574e 6907name>} can be omitted if the mode of the tuple is unambiguous. This
cce74817
JM
6908unambiguity is derived from the context of a evaluated expression.
6909@code{<tuple>} can be one of the following:
d4f3574e 6910
cce74817
JM
6911@itemize @bullet
6912@item @emph{Powerset Tuple}
6913@item @emph{Array Tuple}
6914@item @emph{Structure Tuple}
6915Powerset tuples, array tuples and structure tuples are specified in the
d4f3574e 6916same manner as in Chill programs refer to z200/88 chpt 5.2.5.
cce74817
JM
6917@end itemize
6918
6919@item String Element Value
6920A string element value is specified by @code{<string value>(<index>)},
d4f3574e 6921where @code{<index>} is a integer expression. It delivers a character
cce74817
JM
6922value which is equivalent to the character indexed by @code{<index>} in
6923the string.
6924
6925@item String Slice Value
6926A string slice value is specified by @code{<string value>(<slice
6927spec>)}, where @code{<slice spec>} can be either a range of integer
6928expressions or specified by @code{<start expr> up <size>}.
6929@code{<size>} denotes the number of elements which the slice contains.
6930The delivered value is a string value, which is part of the specified
6931string.
6932
6933@item Array Element Values
6934An array element value is specified by @code{<array value>(<expr>)} and
6935delivers a array element value of the mode of the specified array.
6936
6937@item Array Slice Values
6938An array slice is specified by @code{<array value>(<slice spec>)}, where
6939@code{<slice spec>} can be either a range specified by expressions or by
d4f3574e
SS
6940@code{<start expr> up <size>}. @code{<size>} denotes the number of
6941arrayelements the slice contains. The delivered value is an array value
cce74817
JM
6942which is part of the specified array.
6943
6944@item Structure Field Values
6945A structure field value is derived by @code{<structure value>.<field
d4f3574e
SS
6946name>}, where @code{<field name>} indicates the name of a field specified
6947in the mode definition of the structure. The mode of the delivered value
cce74817
JM
6948corresponds to this mode definition in the structure definition.
6949
6950@item Procedure Call Value
6951The procedure call value is derived from the return value of the
6952procedure@footnote{If a procedure call is used for instance in an
6953expression, then this procedure is called with all its side
d4f3574e 6954effects. This can lead to confusing results if used carelessly.}.
cce74817 6955
d4f3574e 6956Values of duration mode locations are represented by @code{ULONG} literals.
cce74817 6957
d4f3574e 6958Values of time mode locations are represented by @code{TIME(<secs>:<nsecs>)}.
cce74817
JM
6959
6960@ignore
6961This is not implemented yet:
6962@item Built-in Value
6963@noindent
6964The following built in functions are provided:
d4f3574e 6965
cce74817
JM
6966@table @code
6967@item @code{ADDR()}
6968@item @code{NUM()}
6969@item @code{PRED()}
6970@item @code{SUCC()}
6971@item @code{ABS()}
6972@item @code{CARD()}
6973@item @code{MAX()}
6974@item @code{MIN()}
6975@item @code{SIZE()}
6976@item @code{UPPER()}
6977@item @code{LOWER()}
6978@item @code{LENGTH()}
6979@item @code{SIN()}
6980@item @code{COS()}
6981@item @code{TAN()}
6982@item @code{ARCSIN()}
6983@item @code{ARCCOS()}
6984@item @code{ARCTAN()}
6985@item @code{EXP()}
6986@item @code{LN()}
6987@item @code{LOG()}
6988@item @code{SQRT()}
6989@end table
6990
6991For a detailed description refer to the GNU Chill implementation manual
6992chapter 1.6.
6993@end ignore
6994
6995@item Zero-adic Operator Value
6996The zero-adic operator value is derived from the instance value for the
6997current active process.
6998
6999@item Expression Values
7000The value delivered by an expression is the result of the evaluation of
d4f3574e 7001the specified expression. If there are error conditions (mode
cce74817 7002incompatibility, etc.) the evaluation of expressions is aborted with a
d4f3574e 7003corresponding error message. Expressions may be parenthesised which
cce74817 7004causes the evaluation of this expression before any other expression
d4f3574e 7005which uses the result of the parenthesised expression. The following
cce74817 7006operators are supported by @value{GDBN}:
d4f3574e 7007
cce74817
JM
7008@table @code
7009@item @code{OR, ORIF, XOR}
d4f3574e
SS
7010@itemx @code{AND, ANDIF}
7011@itemx @code{NOT}
cce74817 7012Logical operators defined over operands of boolean mode.
d4f3574e 7013
cce74817
JM
7014@item @code{=, /=}
7015Equality and inequality operators defined over all modes.
d4f3574e 7016
cce74817 7017@item @code{>, >=}
d4f3574e 7018@itemx @code{<, <=}
cce74817 7019Relational operators defined over predefined modes.
d4f3574e 7020
cce74817 7021@item @code{+, -}
d4f3574e 7022@itemx @code{*, /, MOD, REM}
cce74817 7023Arithmetic operators defined over predefined modes.
d4f3574e 7024
cce74817
JM
7025@item @code{-}
7026Change sign operator.
d4f3574e 7027
cce74817
JM
7028@item @code{//}
7029String concatenation operator.
d4f3574e 7030
cce74817
JM
7031@item @code{()}
7032String repetition operator.
d4f3574e 7033
cce74817
JM
7034@item @code{->}
7035Referenced location operator which can be used either to take the
7036address of a location (@code{->loc}), or to dereference a reference
7037location (@code{loc->}).
d4f3574e 7038
cce74817 7039@item @code{OR, XOR}
d4f3574e
SS
7040@itemx @code{AND}
7041@itemx @code{NOT}
cce74817 7042Powerset and bitstring operators.
d4f3574e 7043
cce74817 7044@item @code{>, >=}
d4f3574e 7045@itemx @code{<, <=}
cce74817 7046Powerset inclusion operators.
d4f3574e 7047
cce74817
JM
7048@item @code{IN}
7049Membership operator.
7050@end table
7051@end table
7052
53a5351d 7053@node Chill type and range checks
cce74817
JM
7054@subsubsection Chill type and range checks
7055
7056@value{GDBN} considers two Chill variables mode equivalent if the sizes
d4f3574e 7057of the two modes are equal. This rule applies recursively to more
cce74817 7058complex datatypes which means that complex modes are treated
d4f3574e 7059equivalent if all element modes (which also can be complex modes like
cce74817
JM
7060structures, arrays, etc.) have the same size.
7061
7062Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
7063index bounds and all built in procedures.
7064
7065Strong type checks are forced using the @value{GDBN} command @code{set
d4f3574e 7066check strong}. This enforces strong type and range checks on all
cce74817
JM
7067operations where Chill constructs are used (expressions, built in
7068functions, etc.) in respect to the semantics as defined in the z.200
7069language specification.
7070
cce74817
JM
7071All checks can be disabled by the @value{GDBN} command @code{set check
7072off}.
7073
7074@ignore
53a5351d 7075@c Deviations from the Chill Standard Z200/88
cce74817
JM
7076see last paragraph ?
7077@end ignore
7078
53a5351d 7079@node Chill defaults
cce74817
JM
7080@subsubsection Chill defaults
7081
7082If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
7083both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
d4f3574e 7084Chill. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
cce74817
JM
7085selected the working language.
7086
7087If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
7088code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.ch} sets the
d4f3574e 7089working language to Chill. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} set
cce74817
JM
7090the language automatically}, for further details.
7091
53a5351d 7092@node Symbols
c906108c
SS
7093@chapter Examining the Symbol Table
7094
d4f3574e 7095The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
c906108c
SS
7096symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
7097program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
7098does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
7099program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
7100(@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing files}), or by one of the
7101file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
7102
7103@cindex symbol names
7104@cindex names of symbols
7105@cindex quoting names
7106Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
7107characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
7108most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
7109source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program variables}). File names
7110are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
7111ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
7112@samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
7113@samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
7114
7115@example
7116p 'foo.c'::x
7117@end example
7118
7119@noindent
7120looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
7121
7122@table @code
7123@kindex info address
7124@item info address @var{symbol}
7125Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
7126variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
7127local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
7128is always stored.
7129
7130Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
7131at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
7132the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
7133
7134@kindex whatis
d4f3574e
SS
7135@item whatis @var{expr}
7136Print the data type of expression @var{expr}. @var{expr} is not
c906108c
SS
7137actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
7138assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
7139@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
7140
7141@item whatis
7142Print the data type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
7143
7144@kindex ptype
7145@item ptype @var{typename}
7146Print a description of data type @var{typename}. @var{typename} may be
7a292a7a
SS
7147the name of a type, or for C code it may have the form @samp{class
7148@var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
7149@var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
c906108c 7150
d4f3574e 7151@item ptype @var{expr}
c906108c 7152@itemx ptype
d4f3574e 7153Print a description of the type of expression @var{expr}. @code{ptype}
c906108c
SS
7154differs from @code{whatis} by printing a detailed description, instead
7155of just the name of the type.
7156
7157For example, for this variable declaration:
7158
7159@example
7160struct complex @{double real; double imag;@} v;
7161@end example
7162
7163@noindent
7164the two commands give this output:
7165
7166@example
7167@group
7168(@value{GDBP}) whatis v
7169type = struct complex
7170(@value{GDBP}) ptype v
7171type = struct complex @{
7172 double real;
7173 double imag;
7174@}
7175@end group
7176@end example
7177
7178@noindent
7179As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
7180the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
7181
7182@kindex info types
7183@item info types @var{regexp}
7184@itemx info types
d4f3574e 7185Print a brief description of all types whose names match @var{regexp}
c906108c
SS
7186(or all types in your program, if you supply no argument). Each
7187complete typename is matched as though it were a complete line; thus,
7188@samp{i type value} gives information on all types in your program whose
d4f3574e 7189names include the string @code{value}, but @samp{i type ^value$} gives
c906108c
SS
7190information only on types whose complete name is @code{value}.
7191
7192This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
7193@code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
7194lists all source files where a type is defined.
7195
7196@kindex info source
7197@item info source
7198Show the name of the current source file---that is, the source file for
7199the function containing the current point of execution---and the language
7200it was written in.
7201
7202@kindex info sources
7203@item info sources
7204Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
7205debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
7206have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
7207
7208@kindex info functions
7209@item info functions
7210Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
7211
7212@item info functions @var{regexp}
7213Print the names and data types of all defined functions
7214whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
7215Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
7216include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
7217start with @code{step}.
7218
7219@kindex info variables
7220@item info variables
7221Print the names and data types of all variables that are declared
7222outside of functions (i.e., excluding local variables).
7223
7224@item info variables @var{regexp}
7225Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
7226variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
7227@var{regexp}.
7228
7229@ignore
7230This was never implemented.
7231@kindex info methods
7232@item info methods
7233@itemx info methods @var{regexp}
7234The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
7235methods within C++ program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
7236specific set of methods found in the various C++ classes. Many
7237C++ classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
7238from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
7239@code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
7240which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
7241@end ignore
7242
c906108c
SS
7243@cindex reloading symbols
7244Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to
7a292a7a
SS
7245be replaced without stopping and restarting your program. For example,
7246in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on
7247running. If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow
7248@value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:
c906108c
SS
7249
7250@table @code
7251@kindex set symbol-reloading
7252@item set symbol-reloading on
7253Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an
7254object file with a particular name is seen again.
7255
7256@item set symbol-reloading off
7257Do not replace symbol definitions when re-encountering object files of
7258the same name. This is the default state; if you are not running on a
7259system that permits automatically relinking modules, you should leave
7260@code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN} may discard symbols
7261when linking large programs, that may contain several modules (from
7262different directories or libraries) with the same name.
7263
7264@kindex show symbol-reloading
7265@item show symbol-reloading
7266Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting.
7267@end table
c906108c 7268
c906108c
SS
7269@kindex set opaque-type-resolution
7270@item set opaque-type-resolution on
7271Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
7272declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
7273@code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
7274source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
7275another source file. The default is on.
7276
7277A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
7278the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
7279
7280@item set opaque-type-resolution off
7281Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
7282is printed as follows:
7283@smallexample
7284@{<no data fields>@}
7285@end smallexample
7286
7287@kindex show opaque-type-resolution
7288@item show opaque-type-resolution
7289Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
c906108c
SS
7290
7291@kindex maint print symbols
7292@cindex symbol dump
7293@kindex maint print psymbols
7294@cindex partial symbol dump
7295@item maint print symbols @var{filename}
7296@itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
7297@itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
7298Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
7299These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
7300symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
7301symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
7302collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
7303only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
7304command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
7305use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
7306symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
7307files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
7308@samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
7309required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
7310@xref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}, for a discussion of how
7311@value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
7312@end table
7313
53a5351d 7314@node Altering
c906108c
SS
7315@chapter Altering Execution
7316
7317Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
7318find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
7319correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
7320experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
7321program.
7322
7323For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
7a292a7a
SS
7324locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
7325address, or even return prematurely from a function.
c906108c
SS
7326
7327@menu
7328* Assignment:: Assignment to variables
7329* Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
c906108c 7330* Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
c906108c
SS
7331* Returning:: Returning from a function
7332* Calling:: Calling your program's functions
7333* Patching:: Patching your program
7334@end menu
7335
53a5351d 7336@node Assignment
c906108c
SS
7337@section Assignment to variables
7338
7339@cindex assignment
7340@cindex setting variables
7341To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
7342@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
7343
7344@example
7345print x=4
7346@end example
7347
7348@noindent
7349stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
7350value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
c906108c
SS
7351@xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
7352information on operators in supported languages.
c906108c
SS
7353
7354@kindex set variable
7355@cindex variables, setting
7356If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
7357@code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
7358really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
7359not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
7360,Value history}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
7361
c906108c
SS
7362If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
7363appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
7364variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
7365to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
7366program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
7367a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
7368command @code{set width}:
7369
7370@example
7371(@value{GDBP}) whatis width
7372type = double
7373(@value{GDBP}) p width
7374$4 = 13
7375(@value{GDBP}) set width=47
7376Invalid syntax in expression.
7377@end example
7378
7379@noindent
7380The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
7381order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
7382
7383@example
7384(@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
7385@end example
53a5351d 7386
c906108c
SS
7387Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
7388with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
7389@code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
7390your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
7391to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
7392the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
7393
7394@example
7395@group
7396(@value{GDBP}) whatis g
7397type = double
7398(@value{GDBP}) p g
7399$1 = 1
7400(@value{GDBP}) set g=4
2df3850c 7401(@value{GDBP}) p g
c906108c
SS
7402$2 = 1
7403(@value{GDBP}) r
7404The program being debugged has been started already.
7405Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
7406Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
7407"/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols: Invalid bfd target.
7408(@value{GDBP}) show g
7409The current BFD target is "=4".
7410@end group
7411@end example
7412
7413@noindent
7414The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
7415@code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
7416@code{g}, use
7417
7418@example
7419(@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
7420@end example
c906108c
SS
7421
7422@value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
7423freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
7424and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
7425same length or shorter.
7426@comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
7427@comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
7428
7429To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
7430construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
7431(@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
7432to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
7433and representation in memory), and
7434
7435@example
7436set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
7437@end example
7438
7439@noindent
7440stores the value 4 into that memory location.
7441
53a5351d 7442@node Jumping
c906108c
SS
7443@section Continuing at a different address
7444
7445Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
7446it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
7447an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
7448
7449@table @code
7450@kindex jump
7451@item jump @var{linespec}
7452Resume execution at line @var{linespec}. Execution stops again
7453immediately if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{List, ,Printing
7454source lines}, for a description of the different forms of
7455@var{linespec}. It is common practice to use the @code{tbreak} command
7456in conjunction with @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
7457breakpoints}.
7458
7459The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
7460the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
7461register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
7462a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
7463be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
7464of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
7465confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
7466executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
7467well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
7468
7469@item jump *@var{address}
7470Resume execution at the instruction at address @var{address}.
7471@end table
7472
c906108c 7473@c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
53a5351d
JM
7474On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
7475command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
7476difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
7477changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
7478example,
c906108c
SS
7479
7480@example
7481set $pc = 0x485
7482@end example
7483
7484@noindent
7485makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
7486address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
7487@xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}.
c906108c
SS
7488
7489The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
7490up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
7491that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
7492detail.
7493
c906108c 7494@c @group
53a5351d 7495@node Signaling
c906108c
SS
7496@section Giving your program a signal
7497
7498@table @code
7499@kindex signal
7500@item signal @var{signal}
7501Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
7502signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
7503signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
7504SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
7505
7506Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
7507giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
7508a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
7509@code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
7510signal.
7511
7512@code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
7513after executing the command.
7514@end table
7515@c @end group
7516
7517Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
7518@code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
7519causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
7520the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
7521passes the signal directly to your program.
7522
c906108c 7523
53a5351d 7524@node Returning
c906108c
SS
7525@section Returning from a function
7526
7527@table @code
7528@cindex returning from a function
7529@kindex return
7530@item return
7531@itemx return @var{expression}
7532You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
7533command. If you give an
7534@var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
7535value.
7536@end table
7537
7538When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
7539(and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
7540discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
7541be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
7542
7543This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
7544frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
7545innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
7546specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
7547of functions.
7548
7549The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
7550program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
7551returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
7552and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}) resumes execution until the
7553selected stack frame returns naturally.
7554
53a5351d 7555@node Calling
c906108c
SS
7556@section Calling program functions
7557
7558@cindex calling functions
7559@kindex call
7560@table @code
7561@item call @var{expr}
7562Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
7563returned values.
7564@end table
7565
7566You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
7567execute a function from your program, but without cluttering the output
7568with @code{void} returned values. If the result is not void, it
7569is printed and saved in the value history.
7570
c906108c
SS
7571For the A29K, a user-controlled variable @code{call_scratch_address},
7572specifies the location of a scratch area to be used when @value{GDBN}
7573calls a function in the target. This is necessary because the usual
7574method of putting the scratch area on the stack does not work in systems
7575that have separate instruction and data spaces.
c906108c 7576
53a5351d 7577@node Patching
c906108c 7578@section Patching programs
7a292a7a 7579
c906108c
SS
7580@cindex patching binaries
7581@cindex writing into executables
c906108c 7582@cindex writing into corefiles
c906108c 7583
7a292a7a
SS
7584By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
7585executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
7586alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
7587patching your program's binary.
c906108c
SS
7588
7589If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
7590explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
7591want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
7592repairs.
7593
7594@table @code
7595@kindex set write
7596@item set write on
7597@itemx set write off
7a292a7a
SS
7598If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
7599core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @samp{set write
c906108c
SS
7600off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
7601
7602If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
7a292a7a
SS
7603@code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
7604write}, for your new setting to take effect.
c906108c
SS
7605
7606@item show write
7607@kindex show write
7a292a7a
SS
7608Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
7609as well as reading.
c906108c
SS
7610@end table
7611
53a5351d 7612@node GDB Files
c906108c
SS
7613@chapter @value{GDBN} Files
7614
7a292a7a
SS
7615@value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
7616both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
7617program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
7618@value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
c906108c
SS
7619
7620@menu
7621* Files:: Commands to specify files
7622* Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
7623@end menu
7624
53a5351d 7625@node Files
c906108c 7626@section Commands to specify files
c906108c 7627
7a292a7a 7628@cindex symbol table
c906108c 7629@cindex core dump file
7a292a7a
SS
7630
7631You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
7632way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
7633@value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
7634Out of @value{GDBN}}).
c906108c
SS
7635
7636Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
7637@value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to specify
7638a file you want to use. In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands
7639to specify new files are useful.
7640
7641@table @code
7642@cindex executable file
7643@kindex file
7644@item file @var{filename}
7645Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
7646symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
7647executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
7648directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
7649@value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
7650directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
7651to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
7652and your program, using the @code{path} command.
7653
c906108c
SS
7654On systems with memory-mapped files, an auxiliary file
7655@file{@var{filename}.syms} may hold symbol table information for
7656@var{filename}. If so, @value{GDBN} maps in the symbol table from
7657@file{@var{filename}.syms}, starting up more quickly. See the
7658descriptions of the file options @samp{-mapped} and @samp{-readnow}
7659(available on the command line, and with the commands @code{file},
7660@code{symbol-file}, or @code{add-symbol-file}, described below),
7661for more information.
c906108c
SS
7662
7663@item file
7664@code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
7665has on both executable file and the symbol table.
7666
7667@kindex exec-file
7668@item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
7669Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
7670in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
7671if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
7672discard information on the executable file.
7673
7674@kindex symbol-file
7675@item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
7676Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
7677searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
7678table and program to run from the same file.
7679
7680@code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
7681program's symbol table.
7682
7683The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents
7684of its convenience variables, the value history, and all breakpoints and
7685auto-display expressions. This is because they may contain pointers to
7686the internal data recording symbols and data types, which are part of
7687the old symbol table data being discarded inside @value{GDBN}.
7688
7689@code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
7690executing it once.
7691
7692When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
7693understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
7694generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
7695other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
c906108c
SS
7696Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
7697using @code{@value{GCC}} you can generate debugging information for
7698optimized code.
c906108c
SS
7699
7700For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
7701using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
7702symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
7703quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
7704details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
7705
7706The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
7707start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
7708occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
7709file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
7710pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
7711warnings and messages}.)
7712
c906108c
SS
7713We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
7714symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
7715symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
7716still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
7717in stabs format.
7718
7719@kindex readnow
7720@cindex reading symbols immediately
7721@cindex symbols, reading immediately
7722@kindex mapped
7723@cindex memory-mapped symbol file
7724@cindex saving symbol table
7725@item symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
7726@itemx file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
7727You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
7728tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
7729load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
7730entire symbol table available.
c906108c 7731
c906108c
SS
7732If memory-mapped files are available on your system through the
7733@code{mmap} system call, you can use another option, @samp{-mapped}, to
7734cause @value{GDBN} to write the symbols for your program into a reusable
7735file. Future @value{GDBN} debugging sessions map in symbol information
7736from this auxiliary symbol file (if the program has not changed), rather
7737than spending time reading the symbol table from the executable
7738program. Using the @samp{-mapped} option has the same effect as
7739starting @value{GDBN} with the @samp{-mapped} command-line option.
7740
7741You can use both options together, to make sure the auxiliary symbol
7742file has all the symbol information for your program.
7743
7744The auxiliary symbol file for a program called @var{myprog} is called
7745@samp{@var{myprog}.syms}. Once this file exists (so long as it is newer
7746than the corresponding executable), @value{GDBN} always attempts to use
7747it when you debug @var{myprog}; no special options or commands are
7748needed.
7749
7750The @file{.syms} file is specific to the host machine where you run
7751@value{GDBN}. It holds an exact image of the internal @value{GDBN}
7752symbol table. It cannot be shared across multiple host platforms.
c906108c
SS
7753
7754@c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
7755@c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
7756@c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
7757@c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
7758@c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
7759@c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
7760@c files.
7761
7762@kindex core
7763@kindex core-file
7764@item core-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
7765Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
7766of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
7767address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
7768executable file itself for other parts.
7769
7770@code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
7771to be used.
7772
7773Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
7a292a7a
SS
7774under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
7775wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
7776the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
c906108c 7777(@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the child process}).
c906108c 7778
c906108c
SS
7779@kindex add-symbol-file
7780@cindex dynamic linking
7781@item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
7782@itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
2acceee2
JM
7783@itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @var{data_address} @var{bss_address}
7784@itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{-T}@var{section} @var{address}
c906108c
SS
7785The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table information
7786from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command when @var{filename}
7787has been dynamically loaded (by some other means) into the program that
7788is running. @var{address} should be the memory address at which the
7789file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure this out for itself.
2acceee2
JM
7790You can specify up to three addresses, in which case they are taken to be
7791the addresses of the text, data, and bss segments respectively.
7792For complicated cases, you can specify an arbitrary number of @r{-T}@var{section} @var{address}
7793pairs, to give an explicit section name and base address for that section.
7794You can specify any @var{address} as an expression.
c906108c
SS
7795
7796The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
7797originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
7798@code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data thus
7799read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data instead,
7800use the @code{symbol-file} command.
7801
7802@code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
7803
7804You can use the @samp{-mapped} and @samp{-readnow} options just as with
7805the @code{symbol-file} command, to change how @value{GDBN} manages the symbol
7806table information for @var{filename}.
7807
7808@kindex add-shared-symbol-file
7809@item add-shared-symbol-file
7810The @code{add-shared-symbol-file} command can be used only under Harris' CXUX
7811operating system for the Motorola 88k. @value{GDBN} automatically looks for
7812shared libraries, however if @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can run
7813@code{add-shared-symbol-file}. It takes no arguments.
c906108c 7814
c906108c
SS
7815@kindex section
7816@item section
7817The @code{section} command changes the base address of section SECTION of
7818the exec file to ADDR. This can be used if the exec file does not contain
7819section addresses, (such as in the a.out format), or when the addresses
7820specified in the file itself are wrong. Each section must be changed
d4f3574e
SS
7821separately. The @code{info files} command, described below, lists all
7822the sections and their addresses.
c906108c
SS
7823
7824@kindex info files
7825@kindex info target
7826@item info files
7827@itemx info target
7a292a7a
SS
7828@code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
7829current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
7830including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
7831use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
7832command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
7833current ones.
7834
c906108c
SS
7835@end table
7836
7837All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
7838as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
7839name and remembers it that way.
7840
c906108c 7841@cindex shared libraries
c906108c
SS
7842@value{GDBN} supports HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix 5, and IBM RS/6000 shared
7843libraries.
53a5351d 7844
c906108c
SS
7845@value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
7846when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
7847(Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
7848references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
7849debugging a core file).
53a5351d
JM
7850
7851On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
7852automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
7853
c906108c
SS
7854@c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
7855@c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
7856@c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
7857
7858@table @code
7859@kindex info sharedlibrary
7860@kindex info share
7861@item info share
7862@itemx info sharedlibrary
7863Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded.
7864
7865@kindex sharedlibrary
7866@kindex share
7867@item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
7868@itemx share @var{regex}
c906108c
SS
7869Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
7870Unix regular expression.
7871As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
7872required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
7873@var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
7874loaded.
7875@end table
7876
53a5351d
JM
7877On HP-UX systems, @value{GDBN} detects the loading of a shared library
7878and automatically reads in symbols from the newly loaded library, up to
7879a threshold that is initially set but that you can modify if you wish.
c906108c
SS
7880
7881Beyond that threshold, symbols from shared libraries must be explicitly
d4f3574e
SS
7882loaded. To load these symbols, use the command @code{sharedlibrary
7883@var{filename}}. The base address of the shared library is determined
c906108c
SS
7884automatically by @value{GDBN} and need not be specified.
7885
7886To display or set the threshold, use the commands:
7887
7888@table @code
7889@kindex set auto-solib-add
7890@item set auto-solib-add @var{threshold}
7891Set the autoloading size threshold, in megabytes. If @var{threshold} is
7892nonzero, symbols from all shared object libraries will be loaded
7893automatically when the inferior begins execution or when the dynamic
7894linker informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded, until
7895the symbol table of the program and libraries exceeds this threshold.
7896Otherwise, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
7897@code{sharedlibrary} command. The default threshold is 100 megabytes.
7898
7899@kindex show auto-solib-add
7900@item show auto-solib-add
7901Display the current autoloading size threshold, in megabytes.
7902@end table
c906108c 7903
53a5351d 7904@node Symbol Errors
c906108c
SS
7905@section Errors reading symbol files
7906
7907While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
7908such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
7909output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
7910they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
7911debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
7912about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
7913only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
7914times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
7915to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
7916complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
7917messages}).
7918
7919The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
7920
7921@table @code
7922@item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
7923
7924The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
7925(such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
7926error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
7927in its outer scope blocks.
7928
7929@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
7930the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
7931may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
7932function.
7933
7934@item block at @var{address} out of order
7935
7936The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
7937order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
7938do so.
7939
7940@value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
7941locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
7942can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
7943@code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
7944messages}.)
7945
7946@item bad block start address patched
7947
7948The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
7949smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
7950to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
7951
7952@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
7953starting on the previous source line.
7954
7955@item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
7956
7957@cindex foo
7958Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
7959larger than the size of the string table.
7960
7961@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
7962name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
7963with this name.
7964
7965@item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
7966
7a292a7a
SS
7967The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
7968not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
d4f3574e 7969uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
c906108c 7970
7a292a7a
SS
7971@value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
7972This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
c906108c 7973are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
7a292a7a
SS
7974debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
7975on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
7976and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
c906108c
SS
7977
7978@item stub type has NULL name
c906108c 7979
7a292a7a 7980@value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
c906108c 7981
7a292a7a 7982@item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
c906108c 7983The symbol information for a C++ member function is missing some
7a292a7a
SS
7984information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
7985it.
c906108c
SS
7986
7987@item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
7988
7989@value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
7a292a7a 7990
c906108c
SS
7991@end table
7992
53a5351d 7993@node Targets
c906108c 7994@chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
7a292a7a 7995
c906108c
SS
7996@cindex debugging target
7997@kindex target
7998
7999A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
53a5351d
JM
8000
8001Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
8002in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
8003you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
c906108c
SS
8004flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
8005host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
53a5351d
JM
8006realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
8007command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
8008(@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}).
c906108c
SS
8009
8010@menu
8011* Active Targets:: Active targets
8012* Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
c906108c
SS
8013* Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
8014* Remote:: Remote debugging
96baa820 8015* KOD:: Kernel Object Display
c906108c
SS
8016
8017@end menu
8018
53a5351d 8019@node Active Targets
c906108c 8020@section Active targets
7a292a7a 8021
c906108c
SS
8022@cindex stacking targets
8023@cindex active targets
8024@cindex multiple targets
8025
c906108c 8026There are three classes of targets: processes, core files, and
7a292a7a
SS
8027executable files. @value{GDBN} can work concurrently on up to three
8028active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for example)
8029start a process and inspect its activity without abandoning your work on
8030a core file.
c906108c
SS
8031
8032For example, if you execute @samp{gdb a.out}, then the executable file
8033@code{a.out} is the only active target. If you designate a core file as
8034well---presumably from a prior run that crashed and coredumped---then
8035@value{GDBN} has two active targets and uses them in tandem, looking
8036first in the corefile target, then in the executable file, to satisfy
8037requests for memory addresses. (Typically, these two classes of target
8038are complementary, since core files contain only a program's
8039read-write memory---variables and so on---plus machine status, while
8040executable files contain only the program text and initialized data.)
c906108c
SS
8041
8042When you type @code{run}, your executable file becomes an active process
7a292a7a
SS
8043target as well. When a process target is active, all @value{GDBN}
8044commands requesting memory addresses refer to that target; addresses in
8045an active core file or executable file target are obscured while the
8046process target is active.
c906108c 8047
7a292a7a
SS
8048Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new
8049core file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify
c906108c 8050files}). To specify as a target a process that is already running, use
7a292a7a
SS
8051the @code{attach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running
8052process}).
c906108c 8053
53a5351d 8054@node Target Commands
c906108c
SS
8055@section Commands for managing targets
8056
8057@table @code
8058@item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
7a292a7a
SS
8059Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
8060process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
8061facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
8062protocol of the target machine.
c906108c
SS
8063
8064Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
8065typically include things like device names or host names to connect
8066with, process numbers, and baud rates.
c906108c
SS
8067
8068The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
8069after executing the command.
8070
8071@kindex help target
8072@item help target
8073Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
8074currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
8075(@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
8076
8077@item help target @var{name}
8078Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
8079select it.
8080
8081@kindex set gnutarget
8082@item set gnutarget @var{args}
8083@value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
8084knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
8085a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
8086with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
8087with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
8088
d4f3574e 8089@quotation
c906108c
SS
8090@emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
8091you must know the actual BFD name.
d4f3574e 8092@end quotation
c906108c 8093
d4f3574e
SS
8094@noindent
8095@xref{Files, , Commands to specify files}.
c906108c
SS
8096
8097@kindex show gnutarget
8098@item show gnutarget
8099Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
8100@code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
8101@value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
8102and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
8103@end table
8104
c906108c
SS
8105Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
8106configuration):
c906108c
SS
8107
8108@table @code
8109@kindex target exec
8110@item target exec @var{program}
8111An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
8112@samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
8113
c906108c
SS
8114@kindex target core
8115@item target core @var{filename}
8116A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
8117@samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
c906108c
SS
8118
8119@kindex target remote
8120@item target remote @var{dev}
8121Remote serial target in GDB-specific protocol. The argument @var{dev}
8122specifies what serial device to use for the connection (e.g.
8123@file{/dev/ttya}). @xref{Remote, ,Remote debugging}. @code{target remote}
d4f3574e 8124supports the @code{load} command. This is only useful if you have
c906108c
SS
8125some other way of getting the stub to the target system, and you can put
8126it somewhere in memory where it won't get clobbered by the download.
8127
c906108c
SS
8128@kindex target sim
8129@item target sim
2df3850c 8130Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
104c1213
JM
8131In general,
8132@example
8133 target sim
8134 load
8135 run
8136@end example
d4f3574e 8137@noindent
104c1213 8138works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
d4f3574e 8139drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
104c1213
JM
8140provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
8141see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
8142Processors}.
8143
c906108c
SS
8144@end table
8145
104c1213 8146Some configurations may include these targets as well:
c906108c
SS
8147
8148@table @code
8149
c906108c
SS
8150@kindex target nrom
8151@item target nrom @var{dev}
8152NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading.
8153
c906108c
SS
8154@end table
8155
c906108c
SS
8156Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
8157your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
c906108c
SS
8158
8159Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code
8160once you've successfully established a connection.
8161
8162@table @code
8163
8164@kindex load @var{filename}
8165@item load @var{filename}
c906108c
SS
8166Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
8167@value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
8168is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
8169on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
8170@code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
8171the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
8172
8173If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
8174execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
8175target is @dots{}}''
c906108c
SS
8176
8177The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
8178For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
8179link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
8180specifies a fixed address.
8181@c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
8182
c906108c
SS
8183@code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
8184@end table
8185
53a5351d 8186@node Byte Order
c906108c 8187@section Choosing target byte order
7a292a7a 8188
c906108c
SS
8189@cindex choosing target byte order
8190@cindex target byte order
8191@kindex set endian big
8192@kindex set endian little
8193@kindex set endian auto
8194@kindex show endian
8195
8196Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Hitachi SH,
8197offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
8198orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
8199designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
8200which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
d4f3574e 8201@value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
c906108c
SS
8202
8203@table @code
8204@kindex set endian big
8205@item set endian big
8206Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
8207
8208@kindex set endian little
8209@item set endian little
8210Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
8211
8212@kindex set endian auto
8213@item set endian auto
8214Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
8215executable.
8216
8217@item show endian
8218Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
8219
8220@end table
8221
8222Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
8223data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
8224target system.
8225
53a5351d 8226@node Remote
c906108c
SS
8227@section Remote debugging
8228@cindex remote debugging
8229
8230If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
8231@value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
8232For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
8233or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
8234powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
8235
8236Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
8237to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
8238@value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
8239but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
8240write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
8241communicate with @value{GDBN}.
8242
8243Other remote targets may be available in your
8244configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
c906108c 8245
c906108c 8246@menu
c906108c 8247* Remote Serial:: @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol
c906108c
SS
8248@end menu
8249
104c1213
JM
8250@node Remote Serial
8251@subsection The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol
7a292a7a 8252
104c1213
JM
8253@cindex remote serial debugging, overview
8254To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
8255@dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
8256prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
8257program, you need:
c906108c 8258
104c1213
JM
8259@enumerate
8260@item
8261A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
8262have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
8263your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
96baa820 8264
104c1213 8265@item
d4f3574e 8266A C subroutine library to support your program's
104c1213 8267subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
96baa820 8268
104c1213
JM
8269@item
8270A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
8271download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
8272manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
8273documentation.
8274@end enumerate
96baa820 8275
104c1213
JM
8276The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
8277communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
8278machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
96baa820 8279
104c1213
JM
8280@table @emph
8281@item On the host,
8282@value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
8283else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
8284(@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
8285
8286@item On the target,
8287you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
8288implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
8289subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
8290
8291On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
8292@code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
8293@xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} program}, for details.
8294@end table
96baa820 8295
104c1213
JM
8296The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
8297machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
8298@sc{sparc} boards.
96baa820 8299
104c1213
JM
8300@cindex remote serial stub list
8301These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
96baa820 8302
104c1213
JM
8303@table @code
8304
8305@item i386-stub.c
8306@kindex i386-stub.c
8307@cindex Intel
8308@cindex i386
8309For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
8310
8311@item m68k-stub.c
8312@kindex m68k-stub.c
8313@cindex Motorola 680x0
8314@cindex m680x0
8315For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
8316
8317@item sh-stub.c
8318@kindex sh-stub.c
8319@cindex Hitachi
8320@cindex SH
8321For Hitachi SH architectures.
8322
8323@item sparc-stub.c
8324@kindex sparc-stub.c
8325@cindex Sparc
8326For @sc{sparc} architectures.
8327
8328@item sparcl-stub.c
8329@kindex sparcl-stub.c
8330@cindex Fujitsu
8331@cindex SparcLite
8332For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
8333
8334@end table
8335
8336The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
8337recently added stubs.
8338
8339@menu
8340* Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
8341* Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
8342* Debug Session:: Putting it all together
8343* Protocol:: Definition of the communication protocol
8344* Server:: Using the `gdbserver' program
8345* NetWare:: Using the `gdbserve.nlm' program
8346@end menu
8347
8348@node Stub Contents
8349@subsubsection What the stub can do for you
8350
8351@cindex remote serial stub
8352The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
8353subroutines:
8354
8355@table @code
8356@item set_debug_traps
8357@kindex set_debug_traps
8358@cindex remote serial stub, initialization
8359This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
8360program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly near the
8361beginning of your program.
8362
8363@item handle_exception
8364@kindex handle_exception
8365@cindex remote serial stub, main routine
8366This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
8367explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
8368run when a trap is triggered.
8369
8370@code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
8371execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
8372with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
8373protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
d4f3574e 8374representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
104c1213
JM
8375information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
8376retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
8377execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
8378@code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
8379machine.
8380
8381@item breakpoint
8382@cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
8383Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
8384breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
8385way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
8386machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
8387pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
8388@code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
8389simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
8390again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
8391your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
8392@value{GDBN} session gets control.
8393
8394Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
8395to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
8396start of your debugging session.
8397@end table
8398
8399@node Bootstrapping
8400@subsubsection What you must do for the stub
8401
8402@cindex remote stub, support routines
8403The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
8404chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
8405debugging target machine.
8406
8407First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
8408serial port.
8409
8410@table @code
8411@item int getDebugChar()
8412@kindex getDebugChar
8413Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
8414It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
8415different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
8416
8417@item void putDebugChar(int)
8418@kindex putDebugChar
8419Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
8420It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
8421different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
8422@end table
8423
8424@cindex control C, and remote debugging
8425@cindex interrupting remote targets
8426If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
8427running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
8428for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
8429character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
8430remote system to stop.
8431
8432Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
8433probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
8434is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
8435@value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
8436
8437Other routines you need to supply are:
8438
8439@table @code
8440@item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
8441@kindex exceptionHandler
8442Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
8443handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
8444way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
8445are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
8446containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
8447@var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
8448its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
8449might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
8450exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
8451@var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
8452and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
8453you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
8454should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
8455
8456For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
8457gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
8458should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
8459@sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
8460help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
8461
8462@item void flush_i_cache()
8463@kindex flush_i_cache
d4f3574e 8464On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
104c1213
JM
8465instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
8466instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
8467
8468On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
8469function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
8470@end table
8471
8472@noindent
8473You must also make sure this library routine is available:
8474
8475@table @code
8476@item void *memset(void *, int, int)
8477@kindex memset
8478This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
8479memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
8480@code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
8481either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
8482@end table
8483
8484If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
8485library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
8486but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
d4f3574e 8487subroutines which @code{@value{GCC}} generates as inline code.
104c1213
JM
8488
8489
8490@node Debug Session
8491@subsubsection Putting it all together
8492
8493@cindex remote serial debugging summary
8494In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
8495steps.
8496
8497@enumerate
8498@item
8499Make sure you have the supporting low-level routines
8500(@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What you must do for the stub}):
8501@display
8502@code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
8503@code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
8504@end display
8505
8506@item
8507Insert these lines near the top of your program:
8508
8509@example
8510set_debug_traps();
8511breakpoint();
8512@end example
8513
8514@item
8515For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
8516@code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
8517
8518@example
8519void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
8520@end example
8521
d4f3574e 8522@noindent
104c1213 8523but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
d4f3574e 8524function in your program; that function is called when
104c1213
JM
8525@code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
8526error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
8527one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
8528
8529@item
8530Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
8531your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
8532
8533@item
8534Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
8535the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
8536
8537@item
8538@c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
8539@c document that. FIXME.
8540Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
8541whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
8542
8543@item
8544To start remote debugging, run @value{GDBN} on the host machine, and specify
8545as an executable file the program that is running in the remote machine.
8546This tells @value{GDBN} how to find your program's symbols and the contents
8547of its pure text.
8548
d4f3574e 8549@item
104c1213 8550@cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
d4f3574e 8551Establish communication using the @code{target remote} command.
104c1213
JM
8552Its argument specifies how to communicate with the target
8553machine---either via a devicename attached to a direct serial line, or a
8554TCP port (usually to a terminal server which in turn has a serial line
8555to the target). For example, to use a serial line connected to the
8556device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
8557
8558@example
8559target remote /dev/ttyb
8560@end example
8561
8562@cindex TCP port, @code{target remote}
8563To use a TCP connection, use an argument of the form
8564@code{@var{host}:port}. For example, to connect to port 2828 on a
8565terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
8566
8567@example
8568target remote manyfarms:2828
8569@end example
8570@end enumerate
8571
8572Now you can use all the usual commands to examine and change data and to
8573step and continue the remote program.
8574
8575To resume the remote program and stop debugging it, use the @code{detach}
8576command.
8577
8578@cindex interrupting remote programs
8579@cindex remote programs, interrupting
8580Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
8581interrupt character (often @key{C-C}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
8582program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
8583and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
8584interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
8585
8586@example
8587Interrupted while waiting for the program.
8588Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
8589@end example
8590
8591If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
8592(If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
8593remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
8594goes back to waiting.
8595
8596@node Protocol
8597@subsubsection Communication protocol
8598
8599@cindex debugging stub, example
8600@cindex remote stub, example
8601@cindex stub example, remote debugging
8602The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
8603communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
8604@value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
8605these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
8606implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
8607with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
8608organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
8609
8610However, there may be occasions when you need to know something about
8611the protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your
8612target machine, you might want your program to do something special if
8613it recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
8614
8615In the examples below, @samp{<-} and @samp{->} are used to indicate
8616transmitted and received data respectfully.
8617
8618@cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
8619@cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
8620@cindex remote serial protocol
8621All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments)
8622are sent as a @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the
8623character @samp{$}, this is followed by an optional two-digit
8624@var{sequence-id} and the character @samp{:}, the actual
8625@var{packet-data}, and the terminating character @samp{#} followed by a
8626two-digit @var{checksum}:
8627
8628@example
8629@code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
8630@end example
8631@noindent
8632or, with the optional @var{sequence-id}:
8633@example
8634@code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
8635@end example
8636
8637@cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
8638@noindent
8639The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
8640characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (that
8641consisting of both the optional @var{sequence-id}@code{:} and the actual
d4f3574e 8642@var{packet-data}) (an eight bit unsigned checksum).
104c1213
JM
8643
8644@cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
8645@noindent
8646The two-digit @var{sequence-id}, when present, is returned with the
8647acknowledgment. Beyond that its meaning is poorly defined.
8648@value{GDBN} is not known to output @var{sequence-id}s.
8649
8650When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
8651response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
8652the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
8653retransmission):
8654
8655@example
8656<- @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
8657-> @code{+}
8658@end example
8659@noindent
8660If the received packet included a @var{sequence-id} than that is
8661appended to a positive acknowledgment:
8662
8663@example
8664<- @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
8665-> @code{+}@var{sequence-id}
8666@end example
8667
8668The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
8669debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
8670the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
8671when the operation has completed (the target has again stopped).
8672
8673@var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
8674exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for an
8675exception). @samp{:} can not appear as the third character in a packet.
8676Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} and @samp{;}
8677(unfortunately some packets chose to use @samp{:}). Except where
8678otherwise noted all numbers are represented in HEX with leading zeros
8679suppressed.
8680
8681Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space. A @samp{*}
8682means that the next character is an ASCII encoding giving a repeat count
8683which stands for that many repetitions of the character preceding the
8684@samp{*}. The encoding is @code{n+29}, yielding a printable character
d4f3574e
SS
8685where @code{n >=3} (which is where rle starts to win). The printable
8686characters @samp{$}, @samp{#}, @samp{+} and @samp{-} or with a numeric
8687value greater than 126 should not be used.
8688
8689Some remote systems have used a different run-length encoding mechanism
8690loosely refered to as the cisco encoding. Following the @samp{*}
8691character are two hex digits that indicate the size of the packet.
104c1213
JM
8692
8693So:
8694@example
8695"@code{0* }"
8696@end example
8697@noindent
8698means the same as "0000".
8699
8700The error response, returned for some packets includes a two character
8701error number. That number is not well defined.
8702
8703For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
8704(@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
8705protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
d4f3574e 8706on that response.
104c1213
JM
8707
8708Below is a complete list of all currently defined @var{command}s and
8709their corresponding response @var{data}:
8710
8711@multitable @columnfractions .30 .30 .40
8712@item Packet
8713@tab Request
8714@tab Description
8715
8716@item extended ops @emph{(optional)}
8717@tab @code{!}
8718@tab
d4f3574e 8719Use the extended remote protocol. Sticky---only needs to be set once.
104c1213
JM
8720The extended remote protocol support the @samp{R} packet.
8721@item
8722@tab reply @samp{}
8723@tab
8724Stubs that support the extended remote protocol return @samp{} which,
8725unfortunately, is identical to the response returned by stubs that do not
8726support protocol extensions.
8727
8728@item last signal
8729@tab @code{?}
8730@tab
d4f3574e
SS
8731Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for step
8732and continue.
8733@item
8734@tab reply
8735@tab see below
8736
104c1213
JM
8737
8738@item reserved
8739@tab @code{a}
8740@tab Reserved for future use
8741
8742@item set program arguments @strong{(reserved)} @emph{(optional)}
8743@tab @code{A}@var{arglen}@code{,}@var{argnum}@code{,}@var{arg}@code{,...}
8744@tab
8745Initialized @samp{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
8746specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream @var{arg}.
d4f3574e 8747See @file{gdbserver} for more details.
104c1213
JM
8748@item
8749@tab reply @code{OK}
8750@item
8751@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
8752
8753@item set baud @strong{(deprecated)}
8754@tab @code{b}@var{baud}
8755@tab
8756Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}. JTC: @emph{When does the
8757transport layer state change? When it's received, or after the ACK is
8758transmitted. In either case, there are problems if the command or the
8759acknowledgment packet is dropped.} Stan: @emph{If people really wanted
8760to add something like this, and get it working for the first time, they
8761ought to modify ser-unix.c to send some kind of out-of-band message to a
8762specially-setup stub and have the switch happen "in between" packets, so
8763that from remote protocol's point of view, nothing actually
8764happened.}
8765
8766@item set breakpoint @strong{(deprecated)}
8767@tab @code{B}@var{addr},@var{mode}
8768@tab
8769Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
8770breakpoint at @var{addr}. @emph{This has been replaced by the @samp{Z} and
8771@samp{z} packets.}
8772
8773@item continue
8774@tab @code{c}@var{addr}
8775@tab
8776@var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted, resume at
8777current address.
8778@item
8779@tab reply
8780@tab see below
8781
8782@item continue with signal @emph{(optional)}
8783@tab @code{C}@var{sig}@code{;}@var{addr}
8784@tab
8785Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
8786@code{;}@var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
8787@item
8788@tab reply
8789@tab see below
8790
d4f3574e 8791@item toggle debug @emph{(deprecated)}
104c1213
JM
8792@tab @code{d}
8793@tab
d4f3574e 8794toggle debug flag.
104c1213
JM
8795
8796@item detach @emph{(optional)}
8797@tab @code{D}
d4f3574e 8798@tab
2df3850c
JM
8799Detach @value{GDBN} from the remote system. Sent to the remote target before
8800@value{GDBN} disconnects.
d4f3574e
SS
8801@item
8802@tab reply @emph{no response}
8803@tab
2df3850c 8804@value{GDBN} does not check for any response after sending this packet
104c1213
JM
8805
8806@item reserved
8807@tab @code{e}
8808@tab Reserved for future use
8809
8810@item reserved
8811@tab @code{E}
8812@tab Reserved for future use
8813
8814@item reserved
8815@tab @code{f}
8816@tab Reserved for future use
8817
8818@item reserved
8819@tab @code{F}
8820@tab Reserved for future use
8821
8822@item read registers
8823@tab @code{g}
8824@tab Read general registers.
8825@item
8826@tab reply @var{XX...}
8827@tab
8828Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
8829with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
d4f3574e 8830each register and their position within the @samp{g} @var{packet} are
2df3850c 8831determined by the @value{GDBN} internal macros @var{REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and
d4f3574e
SS
8832@var{REGISTER_NAME} macros. The specification of several standard
8833@code{g} packets is specified below.
104c1213
JM
8834@item
8835@tab @code{E}@var{NN}
8836@tab for an error.
8837
8838@item write regs
8839@tab @code{G}@var{XX...}
8840@tab
8841See @samp{g} for a description of the @var{XX...} data.
8842@item
8843@tab reply @code{OK}
8844@tab for success
8845@item
8846@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
8847@tab for an error
8848
8849@item reserved
8850@tab @code{h}
8851@tab Reserved for future use
8852
8853@item set thread @emph{(optional)}
8854@tab @code{H}@var{c}@var{t...}
8855@tab
d4f3574e
SS
8856Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
8857@samp{G}, et.al.). @var{c} = @samp{c} for thread used in step and
8858continue; @var{t...} can be -1 for all threads. @var{c} = @samp{g} for
8859thread used in other operations. If zero, pick a thread, any thread.
104c1213
JM
8860@item
8861@tab reply @code{OK}
8862@tab for success
8863@item
8864@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
8865@tab for an error
8866
d4f3574e
SS
8867@c FIXME: JTC:
8868@c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
8869@c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
8870@c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
8871@c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
8872@c described. For example:
8873@c
8874@c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
8875@c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
8876@c otherwise returns current registers.
8877@c
8878@c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
8879@c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
8880@c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
8881
104c1213
JM
8882@item cycle step @strong{(draft)} @emph{(optional)}
8883@tab @code{i}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{nnn}
8884@tab
8885Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @code{,}@var{nnn} is
8886present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
8887step starting at that address.
8888
8889@item signal then cycle step @strong{(reserved)} @emph{(optional)}
8890@tab @code{I}
8891@tab
8892See @samp{i} and @samp{S} for likely syntax and semantics.
8893
8894@item reserved
8895@tab @code{j}
8896@tab Reserved for future use
8897
8898@item reserved
8899@tab @code{J}
8900@tab Reserved for future use
8901
8902@item kill request @emph{(optional)}
8903@tab @code{k}
8904@tab
d4f3574e
SS
8905FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how operate when a specific
8906thread context has been selected (ie. does 'k' kill only that thread?)}.
104c1213
JM
8907
8908@item reserved
8909@tab @code{l}
8910@tab Reserved for future use
8911
8912@item reserved
8913@tab @code{L}
8914@tab Reserved for future use
8915
8916@item read memory
8917@tab @code{m}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
8918@tab
8919Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
2df3850c 8920Neither @value{GDBN} nor the stub assume that sized memory transfers are assumed
d4f3574e
SS
8921using word alligned accesses. FIXME: @emph{A word aligned memory
8922transfer mechanism is needed.}
104c1213
JM
8923@item
8924@tab reply @var{XX...}
8925@tab
d4f3574e 8926@var{XX...} is mem contents. Can be fewer bytes than requested if able
2df3850c 8927to read only part of the data. Neither @value{GDBN} nor the stub assume that
d4f3574e
SS
8928sized memory transfers are assumed using word alligned accesses. FIXME:
8929@emph{A word aligned memory transfer mechanism is needed.}
104c1213
JM
8930@item
8931@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
8932@tab @var{NN} is errno
8933
8934@item write mem
8935@tab @code{M}@var{addr},@var{length}@code{:}@var{XX...}
8936@tab
8937Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
8938@var{XX...} is the data.
8939@item
8940@tab reply @code{OK}
8941@tab for success
8942@item
8943@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
8944@tab
8945for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
8946written).
8947
8948@item reserved
8949@tab @code{n}
8950@tab Reserved for future use
8951
8952@item reserved
8953@tab @code{N}
8954@tab Reserved for future use
8955
8956@item reserved
8957@tab @code{o}
8958@tab Reserved for future use
8959
8960@item reserved
8961@tab @code{O}
8962@tab Reserved for future use
8963
8964@item read reg @strong{(reserved)}
8965@tab @code{p}@var{n...}
8966@tab
8967See write register.
8968@item
8969@tab return @var{r....}
8970@tab The hex encoded value of the register in target byte order.
8971
8972@item write reg @emph{(optional)}
8973@tab @code{P}@var{n...}@code{=}@var{r...}
8974@tab
8975Write register @var{n...} with value @var{r...}, which contains two hex
8976digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
8977@item
8978@tab reply @code{OK}
8979@tab for success
8980@item
8981@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
8982@tab for an error
8983
8984@item general query @emph{(optional)}
8985@tab @code{q}@var{query}
8986@tab
d4f3574e 8987Request info about @var{query}. In general @value{GDBN} @var{query}'s
104c1213 8988have a leading upper case letter. Custom vendor queries should use a
d4f3574e
SS
8989company prefix (in lower case) ex: @samp{qfsf.var}. @var{query} may
8990optionally be followed by a @samp{,} or @samp{;} separated list. Stubs
8991must ensure that they match the full @var{query} name.
104c1213
JM
8992@item
8993@tab reply @code{XX...}
d4f3574e 8994@tab Hex encoded data from query. The reply can not be empty.
104c1213
JM
8995@item
8996@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
8997@tab error reply
8998@item
8999@tab reply @samp{}
9000@tab Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
9001
104c1213
JM
9002@item general set @emph{(optional)}
9003@tab @code{Q}@var{var}@code{=}@var{val}
9004@tab
9005Set value of @var{var} to @var{val}. See @samp{q} for a discussing of
9006naming conventions.
9007
d4f3574e
SS
9008@item reset @emph{(deprecated)}
9009@tab @code{r}
9010@tab
9011Reset the entire system.
104c1213
JM
9012
9013@item remote restart @emph{(optional)}
9014@tab @code{R}@var{XX}
9015@tab
d4f3574e
SS
9016Restart the remote server. @var{XX} while needed has no clear
9017definition. FIXME: @emph{An example interaction explaining how this
9018packet is used in extended-remote mode is needed}.
104c1213
JM
9019
9020@item step @emph{(optional)}
9021@tab @code{s}@var{addr}
9022@tab
9023@var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted, resume at
9024same address.
9025@item
9026@tab reply
9027@tab see below
9028
9029@item step with signal @emph{(optional)}
9030@tab @code{S}@var{sig}@code{;}@var{addr}
9031@tab
9032Like @samp{C} but step not continue.
9033@item
9034@tab reply
9035@tab see below
9036
9037@item search @emph{(optional)}
9038@tab @code{t}@var{addr}@code{:}@var{PP}@code{,}@var{MM}
9039@tab
9040Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
9041@var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4
d4f3574e 9042bytes. @var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
104c1213
JM
9043
9044@item thread alive @emph{(optional)}
9045@tab @code{T}@var{XX}
9046@tab Find out if the thread XX is alive.
9047@item
9048@tab reply @code{OK}
9049@tab thread is still alive
9050@item
9051@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9052@tab thread is dead
9053
9054@item reserved
9055@tab @code{u}
9056@tab Reserved for future use
9057
9058@item reserved
9059@tab @code{U}
9060@tab Reserved for future use
9061
9062@item reserved
9063@tab @code{v}
9064@tab Reserved for future use
9065
9066@item reserved
9067@tab @code{V}
9068@tab Reserved for future use
9069
9070@item reserved
9071@tab @code{w}
9072@tab Reserved for future use
9073
9074@item reserved
9075@tab @code{W}
9076@tab Reserved for future use
9077
9078@item reserved
9079@tab @code{x}
9080@tab Reserved for future use
9081
9082@item write mem (binary) @emph{(optional)}
9083@tab @code{X}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}@var{:}@var{XX...}
9084@tab
9085@var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes, @var{XX...} is
d4f3574e
SS
9086binary data. The characters @code{$}, @code{#}, and @code{0x7d} are
9087escaped using @code{0x7d}.
104c1213
JM
9088@item
9089@tab reply @code{OK}
9090@tab for success
9091@item
9092@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9093@tab for an error
9094
9095@item reserved
9096@tab @code{y}
9097@tab Reserved for future use
9098
9099@item reserved
9100@tab @code{Y}
9101@tab Reserved for future use
9102
9103@item remove break or watchpoint @strong{(draft)} @emph{(optional)}
9104@tab @code{z}@var{t}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
9105@tab
9106See @samp{Z}.
9107
9108@item insert break or watchpoint @strong{(draft)} @emph{(optional)}
9109@tab @code{Z}@var{t}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
9110@tab
9111@var{t} is type: @samp{0} - software breakpoint, @samp{1} - hardware
9112breakpoint, @samp{2} - write watchpoint, @samp{3} - read watchpoint,
9113@samp{4} - access watchpoint; @var{addr} is address; @var{length} is in
9114bytes. For a software breakpoint, @var{length} specifies the size of
9115the instruction to be patched. For hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
d4f3574e
SS
9116@var{length} specifies the memory region to be monitored. To avoid
9117potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should be
9118implemented in an ident-potentent way.
104c1213
JM
9119@item
9120@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9121@tab for an error
9122@item
9123@tab reply @code{OK}
9124@tab for success
9125@item
9126@tab @samp{}
9127@tab If not supported.
9128
9129@item reserved
9130@tab <other>
9131@tab Reserved for future use
9132
9133@end multitable
9134
d4f3574e
SS
9135The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s} and @samp{?} packets can
9136receive any of the below as a reply. In the case of the @samp{C},
9137@samp{c}, @samp{S} and @samp{s} packets, that reply is only returned
9138when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @samp{signal
9139number} is poorly defined. In general one of the UNIX signal numbering
9140conventions is used.
104c1213
JM
9141
9142@multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
9143
9144@item @code{S}@var{AA}
9145@tab @var{AA} is the signal number
9146
9147@item @code{T}@var{AA}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}
9148@tab
9149@var{AA} = two hex digit signal number; @var{n...} = register number
9150(hex), @var{r...} = target byte ordered register contents, size defined
9151by @code{REGISTER_RAW_SIZE}; @var{n...} = @samp{thread}, @var{r...} =
9152thread process ID, this is a hex integer; @var{n...} = other string not
d4f3574e 9153starting with valid hex digit. @value{GDBN} should ignore this
104c1213
JM
9154@var{n...}, @var{r...} pair and go on to the next. This way we can
9155extend the protocol.
9156
9157@item @code{W}@var{AA}
9158@tab
9159The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
9160applicable for certains sorts of targets.
9161
9162@item @code{X}@var{AA}
9163@tab
9164The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
9165
9166@item @code{N}@var{AA}@code{;}@var{tttttttt}@code{;}@var{dddddddd}@code{;}@var{bbbbbbbb} @strong{(obsolete)}
9167@tab
9168@var{AA} = signal number; @var{tttttttt} = address of symbol "_start";
9169@var{dddddddd} = base of data section; @var{bbbbbbbb} = base of bss
d4f3574e 9170section. @emph{Note: only used by Cisco Systems targets. The difference
104c1213
JM
9171between this reply and the "qOffsets" query is that the 'N' packet may
9172arrive spontaneously whereas the 'qOffsets' is a query initiated by the
9173host debugger.}
9174
9175@item @code{O}@var{XX...}
9176@tab
d4f3574e 9177@var{XX...} is hex encoding of ASCII data. This can happen at any time
104c1213
JM
9178while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
9179for 'W', 'T', etc.
9180
9181@end multitable
9182
d4f3574e
SS
9183The following set and query packets have already been defined.
9184
9185@multitable @columnfractions .2 .2 .6
9186
9187@item current thread
9188@tab @code{q}@code{C}
9189@tab Return the current thread id.
9190@item
9191@tab reply @code{QC}@var{pid}
9192@tab
9193Where @var{pid} is a HEX encoded 16 bit process id.
9194@item
9195@tab reply *
9196@tab Any other reply implies the old pid.
9197
9198@item compute CRC of memory block
9199@tab @code{q}@code{CRC:}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
9200@tab
9201@item
9202@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9203@tab An error (such as memory fault)
9204@item
9205@tab reply @code{C}@var{CRC32}
9206@tab A 32 bit cyclic redundancy check of the specified memory region.
9207
9208@item query @var{LIST} or @var{threadLIST} @strong{(deprecated)}
9209@tab @code{q}@code{L}@var{startflag}@var{threadcount}@var{nextthread}
9210@tab
9211Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
9212digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
9213subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
9214number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
9215(eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
9216returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
9217@item
9218@tab reply @code{q}@code{M}@var{count}@var{done}@var{argthread}@var{thread...}
9219@tab
9220Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
9221returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
9222and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
9223digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread...} is
9224a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
9225digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
9226
9227@item query sect offs
9228@tab @code{q}@code{Offsets}
917317f4
JM
9229@tab
9230Get section offsets that the target used when re-locating the downloaded
9231image. @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset is included in the
9232response, @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data}
9233offset to the @code{Bss} section.}
d4f3574e
SS
9234@item
9235@tab reply @code{Text=}@var{xxx}@code{;Data=}@var{yyy}@code{;Bss=}@var{zzz}
9236
9237@item thread info request
9238@tab @code{q}@code{P}@var{mode}@var{threadid}
9239@tab
9240Returns information on @var{threadid}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
9241encoded 32 bit mode; @var{threadid} is a hex encoded 64 bit thread ID.
9242@item
9243@tab reply *
9244@tab
9245See @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
9246
9247@item remote command
9248@tab @code{q}@code{Rcmd,}@var{COMMAND}
9249@tab
9250@var{COMMAND} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
9251execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output string.
9252Before the final result packet, the target may also respond with a
9253number of intermediate @code{O}@var{OUTPUT} console output
9254packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
9255stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
9256@item
9257@tab reply @code{OK}
9258@tab
9259A command response with no output.
9260@item
9261@tab reply @var{OUTPUT}
9262@tab
9263A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
9264@item
9265@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9266@tab
9267Indicate a badly formed request.
9268
9269@item
9270@tab reply @samp{}
9271@tab
9272When @samp{q}@samp{Rcmd} is not recognized.
9273
9274@end multitable
9275
9276The following @samp{g}/@samp{G} packets have previously been defined.
9277In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as sixty-four
9278bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?) to fill the
9279space allocated. Register bytes are transfered in target byte order.
9280The two nibbles within a register byte are transfered most-significant -
9281least-significant.
9282
9283@multitable @columnfractions .5 .5
9284
9285@item MIPS32
9286@tab
9287All registers are transfered as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
928832 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
9289registers; fsr; fir; fp.
9290
9291@item MIPS64
9292@tab
9293All registers are transfered as sixty-four bit quantities (including
9294thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
9295as @code{MIPS32}.
9296
9297@end multitable
9298
104c1213
JM
9299Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
9300does not get any direct output:
9301
9302@example
9303<- @code{R00}
9304-> @code{+}
9305@emph{target restarts}
9306<- @code{?}
9307-> @code{+}
9308-> @code{T001:1234123412341234}
9309<- @code{+}
9310@end example
9311
9312Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
9313
9314@example
9315<- @code{G1445...}
9316-> @code{+}
9317<- @code{s}
9318-> @code{+}
9319@emph{time passes}
9320-> @code{T001:1234123412341234}
9321<- @code{+}
9322<- @code{g}
9323-> @code{+}
9324-> @code{1455...}
9325<- @code{+}
9326@end example
9327
d4f3574e
SS
9328@kindex set remotedebug@r{, serial protocol}
9329@kindex show remotedebug@r{, serial protocol}
104c1213
JM
9330@cindex packets, reporting on stdout
9331@cindex serial connections, debugging
9332If you have trouble with the serial connection, you can use the command
9333@code{set remotedebug}. This makes @value{GDBN} report on all packets sent
9334back and forth across the serial line to the remote machine. The
9335packet-debugging information is printed on the @value{GDBN} standard output
9336stream. @code{set remotedebug off} turns it off, and @code{show
9337remotedebug} shows you its current state.
9338
9339@node Server
9340@subsubsection Using the @code{gdbserver} program
9341
9342@kindex gdbserver
9343@cindex remote connection without stubs
9344@code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
9345allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
9346@code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
9347
9348@code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
9349because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
9350that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
9351@code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
9352@value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
9353because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
9354also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
9355started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
9356Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
9357the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
9358do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
9359by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
9360choice for debugging.
9361
9362@value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
9363or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
9364protocol.
9365
9366@table @emph
9367@item On the target machine,
9368you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
9369@code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
9370strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
9371system does all the symbol handling.
9372
9373To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
9374the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The
9375syntax is:
9376
9377@smallexample
9378target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
9379@end smallexample
9380
9381@var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP
9382hostname and portnumber. For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
9383@samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
9384@file{/dev/com1}:
9385
9386@smallexample
9387target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
9388@end smallexample
9389
9390@code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
9391with it.
9392
9393To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
9394
9395@smallexample
9396target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
9397@end smallexample
9398
9399The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
9400specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
9401TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
9402expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
9403(Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
9404you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
9405TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
9406reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
9407conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
d4f3574e 9408and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
104c1213
JM
9409@code{target remote} command.
9410
9411@item On the @value{GDBN} host machine,
9412you need an unstripped copy of your program, since @value{GDBN} needs
9413symbols and debugging information. Start up @value{GDBN} as usual,
9414using the name of the local copy of your program as the first argument.
9415(You may also need the @w{@samp{--baud}} option if the serial line is
d4f3574e 9416running at anything other than 9600@dmn{bps}.) After that, use @code{target
104c1213
JM
9417remote} to establish communications with @code{gdbserver}. Its argument
9418is either a device name (usually a serial device, like
9419@file{/dev/ttyb}), or a TCP port descriptor in the form
9420@code{@var{host}:@var{PORT}}. For example:
9421
9422@smallexample
9423(@value{GDBP}) target remote /dev/ttyb
9424@end smallexample
9425
9426@noindent
9427communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and
9428
9429@smallexample
9430(@value{GDBP}) target remote the-target:2345
9431@end smallexample
9432
9433@noindent
9434communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host @w{@file{the-target}}.
9435For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
9436the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
9437text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
9438@samp{Connection refused}.
9439@end table
9440
9441@node NetWare
9442@subsubsection Using the @code{gdbserve.nlm} program
9443
9444@kindex gdbserve.nlm
9445@code{gdbserve.nlm} is a control program for NetWare systems, which
9446allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
9447@code{target remote}.
9448
9449@value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserve.nlm} communicate via a serial line,
9450using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol.
9451
9452@table @emph
9453@item On the target machine,
9454you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
9455@code{gdbserve.nlm} does not need your program's symbol table, so you
9456can strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the
9457host system does all the symbol handling.
9458
9459To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with
9460@value{GDBN}; the name of your program; and the arguments for your
9461program. The syntax is:
9462
9463@smallexample
9464load gdbserve [ BOARD=@var{board} ] [ PORT=@var{port} ]
9465 [ BAUD=@var{baud} ] @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
9466@end smallexample
9467
9468@var{board} and @var{port} specify the serial line; @var{baud} specifies
9469the baud rate used by the connection. @var{port} and @var{node} default
d4f3574e 9470to 0, @var{baud} defaults to 9600@dmn{bps}.
104c1213
JM
9471
9472For example, to debug Emacs with the argument @samp{foo.txt}and
9473communicate with @value{GDBN} over serial port number 2 or board 1
d4f3574e 9474using a 19200@dmn{bps} connection:
104c1213
JM
9475
9476@smallexample
9477load gdbserve BOARD=1 PORT=2 BAUD=19200 emacs foo.txt
9478@end smallexample
9479
9480@item On the @value{GDBN} host machine,
9481you need an unstripped copy of your program, since @value{GDBN} needs
9482symbols and debugging information. Start up @value{GDBN} as usual,
9483using the name of the local copy of your program as the first argument.
9484(You may also need the @w{@samp{--baud}} option if the serial line is
d4f3574e 9485running at anything other than 9600@dmn{bps}. After that, use @code{target
104c1213
JM
9486remote} to establish communications with @code{gdbserve.nlm}. Its
9487argument is a device name (usually a serial device, like
9488@file{/dev/ttyb}). For example:
9489
9490@smallexample
9491(@value{GDBP}) target remote /dev/ttyb
9492@end smallexample
9493
9494@noindent
9495communications with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}.
9496@end table
9497
9498@node KOD
9499@section Kernel Object Display
9500
9501@cindex kernel object display
9502@cindex kernel object
9503@cindex KOD
9504
9505Some targets support kernel object display. Using this facility,
9506@value{GDBN} communicates specially with the underlying operating system
9507and can display information about operating system-level objects such as
9508mutexes and other synchronization objects. Exactly which objects can be
9509displayed is determined on a per-OS basis.
9510
9511Use the @code{set os} command to set the operating system. This tells
9512@value{GDBN} which kernel object display module to initialize:
9513
9514@example
2df3850c 9515(@value{GDBP}) set os cisco
104c1213
JM
9516@end example
9517
9518If @code{set os} succeeds, @value{GDBN} will display some information
9519about the operating system, and will create a new @code{info} command
9520which can be used to query the target. The @code{info} command is named
9521after the operating system:
9522
9523@example
2df3850c 9524(@value{GDBP}) info cisco
104c1213
JM
9525List of Cisco Kernel Objects
9526Object Description
9527any Any and all objects
9528@end example
9529
9530Further subcommands can be used to query about particular objects known
9531by the kernel.
9532
9533There is currently no way to determine whether a given operating system
96baa820
JM
9534is supported other than to try it.
9535
9536
104c1213
JM
9537@node Configurations
9538@chapter Configuration-Specific Information
9539
9540While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
9541cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
9542describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
9543
9544There are three major categories of configurations: native
9545configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
9546operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
9547different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
9548are quite different from each other.
9549
9550@menu
9551* Native::
9552* Embedded OS::
9553* Embedded Processors::
9554* Architectures::
9555@end menu
9556
9557@node Native
9558@section Native
9559
9560This section describes details specific to particular native
9561configurations.
9562
9563@menu
9564* HP-UX:: HP-UX
9565* SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
9566@end menu
9567
9568@node HP-UX
9569@subsection HP-UX
9570
9571On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
9572begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
9573name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
9574
9575@node SVR4 Process Information
9576@subsection SVR4 process information
9577
9578@kindex /proc
9579@cindex process image
9580
9581Many versions of SVR4 provide a facility called @samp{/proc} that can be
9582used to examine the image of a running process using file-system
9583subroutines. If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system with
9584this facility, the command @code{info proc} is available to report on
9585several kinds of information about the process running your program.
9586@code{info proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the
9587@code{procfs} code. This includes OSF/1 (Digital Unix), Solaris, Irix,
9588and Unixware, but not HP-UX or Linux, for example.
9589
9590@table @code
9591@kindex info proc
9592@item info proc
9593Summarize available information about the process.
9594
9595@kindex info proc mappings
9596@item info proc mappings
9597Report on the address ranges accessible in the program, with information
9598on whether your program may read, write, or execute each range.
9599
9600@kindex info proc times
9601@item info proc times
9602Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
9603its children.
9604
9605@kindex info proc id
9606@item info proc id
9607Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
9608the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
9609
9610@kindex info proc status
9611@item info proc status
9612General information on the state of the process. If the process is
9613stopped, this report includes the reason for stopping, and any signal
9614received.
9615
9616@item info proc all
9617Show all the above information about the process.
9618@end table
9619
9620@node Embedded OS
9621@section Embedded Operating Systems
9622
9623This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
9624embedded operating systems that are available for several different
9625architectures.
9626
9627@menu
9628* VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
9629@end menu
9630
9631@value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
9632various real-time operating systems.
9633
9634@node VxWorks
9635@subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
9636
9637@cindex VxWorks
9638
9639@table @code
9640
9641@kindex target vxworks
9642@item target vxworks @var{machinename}
9643A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
9644is the target system's machine name or IP address.
9645
9646@end table
9647
9648On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
9649current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
9650
9651@value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
9652VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
9653the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
9654both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
d4f3574e 9655@code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
104c1213 9656installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
d4f3574e 9657@value{GDB} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
104c1213
JM
9658
9659@table @code
9660@item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
9661@kindex vxworks-timeout
9662All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
9663This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
9664seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
9665your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
9666of a thin network line.
9667@end table
9668
9669The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
9670this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
9671procedures.
9672
9673@kindex INCLUDE_RDB
9674To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
9675to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
9676library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
9677VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
9678kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
9679source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
9680information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
9681manual.
9682@c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
9683
9684Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
9685your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
d4f3574e 9686run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or @code{vxgdb},
104c1213
JM
9687depending on your installation).
9688
9689@value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
9690
9691@example
9692(vxgdb)
9693@end example
9694
9695@menu
9696* VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
9697* VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
9698* VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
9699@end menu
9700
9701@node VxWorks Connection
9702@subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
9703
9704The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
9705network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
9706
9707@example
9708(vxgdb) target vxworks tt
9709@end example
9710
9711@need 750
9712@value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
9713
9714@smallexample
9715Attaching remote machine across net...
9716Connected to tt.
9717@end smallexample
9718
9719@need 1000
9720@value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
9721loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
9722these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
9723path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}); if it fails
9724to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
9725
9726@example
9727prog.o: No such file or directory.
9728@end example
9729
9730When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
9731the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
9732command again.
9733
9734@node VxWorks Download
9735@subsubsection VxWorks download
9736
9737@cindex download to VxWorks
9738If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
9739object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
9740@code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
9741incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
9742command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
9743to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
9744table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
9745the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
9746filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
9747Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
9748to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
9749the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
9750@file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
9751and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
9752program, type this on VxWorks:
9753
9754@example
9755-> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
9756@end example
d4f3574e
SS
9757
9758@noindent
104c1213
JM
9759Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
9760
9761@example
9762(vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
9763(vxgdb) load prog.o
9764@end example
9765
9766@value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
9767
9768@smallexample
9769Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
9770@end smallexample
9771
9772You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
9773after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
9774this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
9775auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
9776history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
d4f3574e 9777debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
104c1213
JM
9778table.)
9779
9780@node VxWorks Attach
9781@subsubsection Running tasks
9782
9783@cindex running VxWorks tasks
9784You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
9785follows:
9786
9787@example
9788(vxgdb) attach @var{task}
9789@end example
9790
9791@noindent
9792where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
9793or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
9794the time of attachment.
9795
9796@node Embedded Processors
9797@section Embedded Processors
9798
9799This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
9800configurations.
9801
9802@menu
9803* A29K Embedded:: AMD A29K Embedded
9804* ARM:: ARM
9805* H8/300:: Hitachi H8/300
9806* H8/500:: Hitachi H8/500
9807* i960:: Intel i960
9808* M32R/D:: Mitsubishi M32R/D
9809* M68K:: Motorola M68K
9810* M88K:: Motorola M88K
9811* MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
9812* PA:: HP PA Embedded
9813* PowerPC: PowerPC
9814* SH:: Hitachi SH
9815* Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
9816* Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
9817* ST2000:: Tandem ST2000
9818* Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
9819@end menu
9820
9821@node A29K Embedded
9822@subsection AMD A29K Embedded
9823
9824@menu
9825* A29K UDI::
9826* A29K EB29K::
9827* Comms (EB29K):: Communications setup
9828* gdb-EB29K:: EB29K cross-debugging
9829* Remote Log:: Remote log
9830@end menu
9831
9832@table @code
9833
9834@kindex target adapt
9835@item target adapt @var{dev}
9836Adapt monitor for A29K.
9837
9838@kindex target amd-eb
9839@item target amd-eb @var{dev} @var{speed} @var{PROG}
9840@cindex AMD EB29K
9841Remote PC-resident AMD EB29K board, attached over serial lines.
9842@var{dev} is the serial device, as for @code{target remote};
9843@var{speed} allows you to specify the linespeed; and @var{PROG} is the
9844name of the program to be debugged, as it appears to DOS on the PC.
9845@xref{A29K EB29K, ,EBMON protocol for AMD29K}.
9846
9847@end table
9848
9849@node A29K UDI
9850@subsubsection A29K UDI
9851
9852@cindex UDI
9853@cindex AMD29K via UDI
9854
9855@value{GDBN} supports AMD's UDI (``Universal Debugger Interface'')
9856protocol for debugging the a29k processor family. To use this
9857configuration with AMD targets running the MiniMON monitor, you need the
9858program @code{MONTIP}, available from AMD at no charge. You can also
9859use @value{GDBN} with the UDI-conformant a29k simulator program
9860@code{ISSTIP}, also available from AMD.
9861
9862@table @code
9863@item target udi @var{keyword}
9864@kindex udi
9865Select the UDI interface to a remote a29k board or simulator, where
9866@var{keyword} is an entry in the AMD configuration file @file{udi_soc}.
9867This file contains keyword entries which specify parameters used to
9868connect to a29k targets. If the @file{udi_soc} file is not in your
9869working directory, you must set the environment variable @samp{UDICONF}
9870to its pathname.
9871@end table
9872
9873@node A29K EB29K
9874@subsubsection EBMON protocol for AMD29K
9875
9876@cindex EB29K board
9877@cindex running 29K programs
9878
9879AMD distributes a 29K development board meant to fit in a PC, together
9880with a DOS-hosted monitor program called @code{EBMON}. As a shorthand
9881term, this development system is called the ``EB29K''. To use
9882@value{GDBN} from a Unix system to run programs on the EB29K board, you
9883must first connect a serial cable between the PC (which hosts the EB29K
9884board) and a serial port on the Unix system. In the following, we
9885assume you've hooked the cable between the PC's @file{COM1} port and
9886@file{/dev/ttya} on the Unix system.
9887
9888@node Comms (EB29K)
9889@subsubsection Communications setup
9890
9891The next step is to set up the PC's port, by doing something like this
9892in DOS on the PC:
9893
9894@example
9895C:\> MODE com1:9600,n,8,1,none
9896@end example
9897
9898@noindent
9899This example---run on an MS DOS 4.0 system---sets the PC port to 9600
9900bps, no parity, eight data bits, one stop bit, and no ``retry'' action;
9901you must match the communications parameters when establishing the Unix
9902end of the connection as well.
9903@c FIXME: Who knows what this "no retry action" crud from the DOS manual may
9904@c mean? It's optional; leave it out? ---doc@cygnus.com, 25feb91
d4f3574e
SS
9905@c
9906@c It's optional, but it's unwise to omit it: who knows what is the
9907@c default value set when the DOS machines boots? "No retry" means that
9908@c the DOS serial device driver won't retry the operation if it fails;
9909@c I understand that this is needed because the GDB serial protocol
9910@c handles any errors and retransmissions itself. ---Eli Zaretskii, 3sep99
104c1213
JM
9911
9912To give control of the PC to the Unix side of the serial line, type
9913the following at the DOS console:
9914
9915@example
9916C:\> CTTY com1
9917@end example
9918
9919@noindent
9920(Later, if you wish to return control to the DOS console, you can use
9921the command @code{CTTY con}---but you must send it over the device that
9922had control, in our example over the @file{COM1} serial line).
9923
9924From the Unix host, use a communications program such as @code{tip} or
9925@code{cu} to communicate with the PC; for example,
9926
9927@example
9928cu -s 9600 -l /dev/ttya
9929@end example
9930
9931@noindent
9932The @code{cu} options shown specify, respectively, the linespeed and the
9933serial port to use. If you use @code{tip} instead, your command line
9934may look something like the following:
9935
9936@example
9937tip -9600 /dev/ttya
9938@end example
9939
9940@noindent
9941Your system may require a different name where we show
9942@file{/dev/ttya} as the argument to @code{tip}. The communications
9943parameters, including which port to use, are associated with the
9944@code{tip} argument in the ``remote'' descriptions file---normally the
9945system table @file{/etc/remote}.
9946@c FIXME: What if anything needs doing to match the "n,8,1,none" part of
9947@c the DOS side's comms setup? cu can support -o (odd
9948@c parity), -e (even parity)---apparently no settings for no parity or
9949@c for character size. Taken from stty maybe...? John points out tip
9950@c can set these as internal variables, eg ~s parity=none; man stty
9951@c suggests that it *might* work to stty these options with stdin or
9952@c stdout redirected... ---doc@cygnus.com, 25feb91
d4f3574e
SS
9953@c
9954@c There's nothing to be done for the "none" part of the DOS MODE
9955@c command. The rest of the parameters should be matched by the
9956@c baudrate, bits, and parity used by the Unix side. ---Eli Zaretskii, 3Sep99
104c1213
JM
9957
9958@kindex EBMON
9959Using the @code{tip} or @code{cu} connection, change the DOS working
9960directory to the directory containing a copy of your 29K program, then
9961start the PC program @code{EBMON} (an EB29K control program supplied
9962with your board by AMD). You should see an initial display from
9963@code{EBMON} similar to the one that follows, ending with the
9964@code{EBMON} prompt @samp{#}---
9965
9966@example
9967C:\> G:
9968
9969G:\> CD \usr\joe\work29k
9970
9971G:\USR\JOE\WORK29K> EBMON
9972Am29000 PC Coprocessor Board Monitor, version 3.0-18
9973Copyright 1990 Advanced Micro Devices, Inc.
9974Written by Gibbons and Associates, Inc.
9975
9976Enter '?' or 'H' for help
9977
9978PC Coprocessor Type = EB29K
9979I/O Base = 0x208
9980Memory Base = 0xd0000
9981
9982Data Memory Size = 2048KB
9983Available I-RAM Range = 0x8000 to 0x1fffff
9984Available D-RAM Range = 0x80002000 to 0x801fffff
9985
9986PageSize = 0x400
9987Register Stack Size = 0x800
9988Memory Stack Size = 0x1800
9989
9990CPU PRL = 0x3
9991Am29027 Available = No
9992Byte Write Available = Yes
9993
9994# ~.
9995@end example
9996
9997Then exit the @code{cu} or @code{tip} program (done in the example by
9998typing @code{~.} at the @code{EBMON} prompt). @code{EBMON} keeps
9999running, ready for @value{GDBN} to take over.
10000
10001For this example, we've assumed what is probably the most convenient
10002way to make sure the same 29K program is on both the PC and the Unix
d4f3574e 10003system: a PC/NFS connection that establishes ``drive @file{G:}'' on the
104c1213
JM
10004PC as a file system on the Unix host. If you do not have PC/NFS or
10005something similar connecting the two systems, you must arrange some
10006other way---perhaps floppy-disk transfer---of getting the 29K program
10007from the Unix system to the PC; @value{GDBN} does @emph{not} download it over the
10008serial line.
10009
10010@node gdb-EB29K
10011@subsubsection EB29K cross-debugging
10012
10013Finally, @code{cd} to the directory containing an image of your 29K
10014program on the Unix system, and start @value{GDBN}---specifying as argument the
10015name of your 29K program:
10016
10017@example
10018cd /usr/joe/work29k
10019@value{GDBP} myfoo
10020@end example
10021
10022@need 500
10023Now you can use the @code{target} command:
10024
10025@example
10026target amd-eb /dev/ttya 9600 MYFOO
10027@c FIXME: test above 'target amd-eb' as spelled, with caps! caps are meant to
10028@c emphasize that this is the name as seen by DOS (since I think DOS is
10029@c single-minded about case of letters). ---doc@cygnus.com, 25feb91
10030@end example
10031
10032@noindent
10033In this example, we've assumed your program is in a file called
10034@file{myfoo}. Note that the filename given as the last argument to
10035@code{target amd-eb} should be the name of the program as it appears to DOS.
10036In our example this is simply @code{MYFOO}, but in general it can include
10037a DOS path, and depending on your transfer mechanism may not resemble
10038the name on the Unix side.
10039
10040At this point, you can set any breakpoints you wish; when you are ready
10041to see your program run on the 29K board, use the @value{GDBN} command
10042@code{run}.
10043
10044To stop debugging the remote program, use the @value{GDBN} @code{detach}
10045command.
10046
10047To return control of the PC to its console, use @code{tip} or @code{cu}
10048once again, after your @value{GDBN} session has concluded, to attach to
10049@code{EBMON}. You can then type the command @code{q} to shut down
10050@code{EBMON}, returning control to the DOS command-line interpreter.
d4f3574e 10051Type @kbd{CTTY con} to return command input to the main DOS console,
104c1213
JM
10052and type @kbd{~.} to leave @code{tip} or @code{cu}.
10053
10054@node Remote Log
10055@subsubsection Remote log
10056@kindex eb.log
10057@cindex log file for EB29K
10058
10059The @code{target amd-eb} command creates a file @file{eb.log} in the
10060current working directory, to help debug problems with the connection.
10061@file{eb.log} records all the output from @code{EBMON}, including echoes
10062of the commands sent to it. Running @samp{tail -f} on this file in
10063another window often helps to understand trouble with @code{EBMON}, or
10064unexpected events on the PC side of the connection.
10065
10066@node ARM
10067@subsection ARM
10068
10069@table @code
10070
10071@kindex target rdi
10072@item target rdi @var{dev}
10073ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
10074use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
10075monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
10076
10077@kindex target rdp
10078@item target rdp @var{dev}
10079ARM Demon monitor.
10080
10081@end table
10082
10083@node H8/300
10084@subsection Hitachi H8/300
10085
10086@table @code
10087
d4f3574e 10088@kindex target hms@r{, with H8/300}
104c1213
JM
10089@item target hms @var{dev}
10090A Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500 board, attached via serial line to your host.
10091Use special commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial
10092line and the communications speed used.
10093
d4f3574e 10094@kindex target e7000@r{, with H8/300}
104c1213
JM
10095@item target e7000 @var{dev}
10096E7000 emulator for Hitachi H8 and SH.
10097
d4f3574e
SS
10098@kindex target sh3@r{, with H8/300}
10099@kindex target sh3e@r{, with H8/300}
104c1213
JM
10100@item target sh3 @var{dev}
10101@item target sh3e @var{dev}
10102Hitachi SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
10103
10104@end table
10105
10106@cindex download to H8/300 or H8/500
10107@cindex H8/300 or H8/500 download
10108@cindex download to Hitachi SH
10109@cindex Hitachi SH download
10110When you select remote debugging to a Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500
10111board, the @code{load} command downloads your program to the Hitachi
10112board and also opens it as the current executable target for
10113@value{GDBN} on your host (like the @code{file} command).
10114
10115@value{GDBN} needs to know these things to talk to your
10116Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500:
10117
10118@enumerate
10119@item
10120that you want to use @samp{target hms}, the remote debugging interface
10121for Hitachi microprocessors, or @samp{target e7000}, the in-circuit
10122emulator for the Hitachi SH and the Hitachi 300H. (@samp{target hms} is
2df3850c 10123the default when @value{GDBN} is configured specifically for the Hitachi SH,
104c1213
JM
10124H8/300, or H8/500.)
10125
10126@item
10127what serial device connects your host to your Hitachi board (the first
10128serial device available on your host is the default).
10129
10130@item
10131what speed to use over the serial device.
10132@end enumerate
10133
10134@menu
10135* Hitachi Boards:: Connecting to Hitachi boards.
10136* Hitachi ICE:: Using the E7000 In-Circuit Emulator.
10137* Hitachi Special:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Hitachi micros.
10138@end menu
10139
10140@node Hitachi Boards
10141@subsubsection Connecting to Hitachi boards
10142
10143@c only for Unix hosts
10144@kindex device
10145@cindex serial device, Hitachi micros
10146Use the special @code{@value{GDBP}} command @samp{device @var{port}} if you
10147need to explicitly set the serial device. The default @var{port} is the
10148first available port on your host. This is only necessary on Unix
10149hosts, where it is typically something like @file{/dev/ttya}.
10150
10151@kindex speed
10152@cindex serial line speed, Hitachi micros
10153@code{@value{GDBP}} has another special command to set the communications
10154speed: @samp{speed @var{bps}}. This command also is only used from Unix
2df3850c 10155hosts; on DOS hosts, set the line speed as usual from outside @value{GDBN} with
d4f3574e
SS
10156the DOS @code{mode} command (for instance,
10157@w{@kbd{mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p}} for a 9600@dmn{bps} connection).
104c1213
JM
10158
10159The @samp{device} and @samp{speed} commands are available only when you
10160use a Unix host to debug your Hitachi microprocessor programs. If you
10161use a DOS host,
10162@value{GDBN} depends on an auxiliary terminate-and-stay-resident program
10163called @code{asynctsr} to communicate with the development board
10164through a PC serial port. You must also use the DOS @code{mode} command
10165to set up the serial port on the DOS side.
10166
10167The following sample session illustrates the steps needed to start a
10168program under @value{GDBN} control on an H8/300. The example uses a
10169sample H8/300 program called @file{t.x}. The procedure is the same for
10170the Hitachi SH and the H8/500.
10171
10172First hook up your development board. In this example, we use a
10173board attached to serial port @code{COM2}; if you use a different serial
10174port, substitute its name in the argument of the @code{mode} command.
10175When you call @code{asynctsr}, the auxiliary comms program used by the
d4f3574e 10176debugger, you give it just the numeric part of the serial port's name;
104c1213
JM
10177for example, @samp{asyncstr 2} below runs @code{asyncstr} on
10178@code{COM2}.
10179
10180@example
10181C:\H8300\TEST> asynctsr 2
10182C:\H8300\TEST> mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p
10183
10184Resident portion of MODE loaded
10185
10186COM2: 9600, n, 8, 1, p
10187
10188@end example
10189
10190@quotation
10191@emph{Warning:} We have noticed a bug in PC-NFS that conflicts with
10192@code{asynctsr}. If you also run PC-NFS on your DOS host, you may need to
10193disable it, or even boot without it, to use @code{asynctsr} to control
10194your development board.
10195@end quotation
10196
d4f3574e 10197@kindex target hms@r{, and serial protocol}
104c1213
JM
10198Now that serial communications are set up, and the development board is
10199connected, you can start up @value{GDBN}. Call @code{@value{GDBP}} with
10200the name of your program as the argument. @code{@value{GDBP}} prompts
10201you, as usual, with the prompt @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. Use two special
10202commands to begin your debugging session: @samp{target hms} to specify
10203cross-debugging to the Hitachi board, and the @code{load} command to
10204download your program to the board. @code{load} displays the names of
10205the program's sections, and a @samp{*} for each 2K of data downloaded.
10206(If you want to refresh @value{GDBN} data on symbols or on the
10207executable file without downloading, use the @value{GDBN} commands
10208@code{file} or @code{symbol-file}. These commands, and @code{load}
10209itself, are described in @ref{Files,,Commands to specify files}.)
10210
10211@smallexample
10212(eg-C:\H8300\TEST) @value{GDBP} t.x
2df3850c 10213@value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
104c1213
JM
10214 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
10215 the conditions.
2df3850c 10216There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
104c1213 10217for details.
2df3850c
JM
10218@value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1992 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
10219(@value{GDBP}) target hms
104c1213 10220Connected to remote H8/300 HMS system.
2df3850c 10221(@value{GDBP}) load t.x
104c1213
JM
10222.text : 0x8000 .. 0xabde ***********
10223.data : 0xabde .. 0xad30 *
10224.stack : 0xf000 .. 0xf014 *
10225@end smallexample
10226
10227At this point, you're ready to run or debug your program. From here on,
10228you can use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands. The @code{break} command
10229sets breakpoints; the @code{run} command starts your program;
10230@code{print} or @code{x} display data; the @code{continue} command
10231resumes execution after stopping at a breakpoint. You can use the
10232@code{help} command at any time to find out more about @value{GDBN} commands.
10233
10234Remember, however, that @emph{operating system} facilities aren't
10235available on your development board; for example, if your program hangs,
10236you can't send an interrupt---but you can press the @sc{reset} switch!
10237
10238Use the @sc{reset} button on the development board
10239@itemize @bullet
10240@item
10241to interrupt your program (don't use @kbd{ctl-C} on the DOS host---it has
10242no way to pass an interrupt signal to the development board); and
10243
10244@item
10245to return to the @value{GDBN} command prompt after your program finishes
10246normally. The communications protocol provides no other way for @value{GDBN}
10247to detect program completion.
10248@end itemize
10249
10250In either case, @value{GDBN} sees the effect of a @sc{reset} on the
10251development board as a ``normal exit'' of your program.
10252
10253@node Hitachi ICE
10254@subsubsection Using the E7000 in-circuit emulator
10255
d4f3574e 10256@kindex target e7000@r{, with Hitachi ICE}
104c1213
JM
10257You can use the E7000 in-circuit emulator to develop code for either the
10258Hitachi SH or the H8/300H. Use one of these forms of the @samp{target
10259e7000} command to connect @value{GDBN} to your E7000:
10260
10261@table @code
10262@item target e7000 @var{port} @var{speed}
10263Use this form if your E7000 is connected to a serial port. The
10264@var{port} argument identifies what serial port to use (for example,
10265@samp{com2}). The third argument is the line speed in bits per second
10266(for example, @samp{9600}).
10267
10268@item target e7000 @var{hostname}
10269If your E7000 is installed as a host on a TCP/IP network, you can just
10270specify its hostname; @value{GDBN} uses @code{telnet} to connect.
10271@end table
10272
10273@node Hitachi Special
10274@subsubsection Special @value{GDBN} commands for Hitachi micros
10275
10276Some @value{GDBN} commands are available only for the H8/300:
10277
10278@table @code
10279
10280@kindex set machine
10281@kindex show machine
10282@item set machine h8300
10283@itemx set machine h8300h
10284Condition @value{GDBN} for one of the two variants of the H8/300
10285architecture with @samp{set machine}. You can use @samp{show machine}
10286to check which variant is currently in effect.
10287
10288@end table
10289
10290@node H8/500
10291@subsection H8/500
10292
10293@table @code
10294
10295@kindex set memory @var{mod}
10296@cindex memory models, H8/500
10297@item set memory @var{mod}
10298@itemx show memory
10299Specify which H8/500 memory model (@var{mod}) you are using with
10300@samp{set memory}; check which memory model is in effect with @samp{show
10301memory}. The accepted values for @var{mod} are @code{small},
10302@code{big}, @code{medium}, and @code{compact}.
10303
10304@end table
10305
10306@node i960
10307@subsection Intel i960
10308
10309@table @code
10310
10311@kindex target mon960
10312@item target mon960 @var{dev}
10313MON960 monitor for Intel i960.
10314
10315@item target nindy @var{devicename}
10316An Intel 960 board controlled by a Nindy Monitor. @var{devicename} is
10317the name of the serial device to use for the connection, e.g.
10318@file{/dev/ttya}.
10319
10320@end table
10321
10322@cindex Nindy
10323@cindex i960
10324@dfn{Nindy} is a ROM Monitor program for Intel 960 target systems. When
10325@value{GDBN} is configured to control a remote Intel 960 using Nindy, you can
10326tell @value{GDBN} how to connect to the 960 in several ways:
10327
10328@itemize @bullet
10329@item
10330Through command line options specifying serial port, version of the
10331Nindy protocol, and communications speed;
10332
10333@item
10334By responding to a prompt on startup;
10335
10336@item
10337By using the @code{target} command at any point during your @value{GDBN}
10338session. @xref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}.
10339
10340@kindex target nindy
10341@item target nindy @var{devicename}
10342An Intel 960 board controlled by a Nindy Monitor. @var{devicename} is
10343the name of the serial device to use for the connection, e.g.
10344@file{/dev/ttya}.
10345
10346@end itemize
10347
10348@cindex download to Nindy-960
10349With the Nindy interface to an Intel 960 board, @code{load}
10350downloads @var{filename} to the 960 as well as adding its symbols in
10351@value{GDBN}.
10352
10353@menu
10354* Nindy Startup:: Startup with Nindy
10355* Nindy Options:: Options for Nindy
10356* Nindy Reset:: Nindy reset command
10357@end menu
10358
10359@node Nindy Startup
10360@subsubsection Startup with Nindy
10361
10362If you simply start @code{@value{GDBP}} without using any command-line
10363options, you are prompted for what serial port to use, @emph{before} you
10364reach the ordinary @value{GDBN} prompt:
10365
10366@example
10367Attach /dev/ttyNN -- specify NN, or "quit" to quit:
10368@end example
10369
10370@noindent
10371Respond to the prompt with whatever suffix (after @samp{/dev/tty})
10372identifies the serial port you want to use. You can, if you choose,
10373simply start up with no Nindy connection by responding to the prompt
10374with an empty line. If you do this and later wish to attach to Nindy,
10375use @code{target} (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}).
10376
10377@node Nindy Options
10378@subsubsection Options for Nindy
10379
10380These are the startup options for beginning your @value{GDBN} session with a
10381Nindy-960 board attached:
10382
10383@table @code
10384@item -r @var{port}
10385Specify the serial port name of a serial interface to be used to connect
10386to the target system. This option is only available when @value{GDBN} is
10387configured for the Intel 960 target architecture. You may specify
10388@var{port} as any of: a full pathname (e.g. @samp{-r /dev/ttya}), a
10389device name in @file{/dev} (e.g. @samp{-r ttya}), or simply the unique
10390suffix for a specific @code{tty} (e.g. @samp{-r a}).
10391
10392@item -O
10393(An uppercase letter ``O'', not a zero.) Specify that @value{GDBN} should use
10394the ``old'' Nindy monitor protocol to connect to the target system.
10395This option is only available when @value{GDBN} is configured for the Intel 960
10396target architecture.
10397
10398@quotation
10399@emph{Warning:} if you specify @samp{-O}, but are actually trying to
10400connect to a target system that expects the newer protocol, the connection
10401fails, appearing to be a speed mismatch. @value{GDBN} repeatedly
10402attempts to reconnect at several different line speeds. You can abort
10403this process with an interrupt.
10404@end quotation
10405
10406@item -brk
10407Specify that @value{GDBN} should first send a @code{BREAK} signal to the target
10408system, in an attempt to reset it, before connecting to a Nindy target.
10409
10410@quotation
10411@emph{Warning:} Many target systems do not have the hardware that this
10412requires; it only works with a few boards.
10413@end quotation
10414@end table
10415
10416The standard @samp{-b} option controls the line speed used on the serial
10417port.
10418
10419@c @group
10420@node Nindy Reset
10421@subsubsection Nindy reset command
10422
10423@table @code
10424@item reset
10425@kindex reset
10426For a Nindy target, this command sends a ``break'' to the remote target
10427system; this is only useful if the target has been equipped with a
10428circuit to perform a hard reset (or some other interesting action) when
10429a break is detected.
10430@end table
10431@c @end group
10432
10433@node M32R/D
10434@subsection Mitsubishi M32R/D
10435
10436@table @code
10437
10438@kindex target m32r
10439@item target m32r @var{dev}
10440Mitsubishi M32R/D ROM monitor.
10441
10442@end table
10443
10444@node M68K
10445@subsection M68k
10446
10447The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and
10448target command for the following ROM monitors.
10449
10450@table @code
10451
10452@kindex target abug
10453@item target abug @var{dev}
10454ABug ROM monitor for M68K.
10455
10456@kindex target cpu32bug
10457@item target cpu32bug @var{dev}
10458CPU32BUG monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
10459
10460@kindex target dbug
10461@item target dbug @var{dev}
10462dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
10463
10464@kindex target est
10465@item target est @var{dev}
10466EST-300 ICE monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
10467
10468@kindex target rom68k
10469@item target rom68k @var{dev}
10470ROM 68K monitor, running on an M68K IDP board.
10471
10472@end table
10473
10474If @value{GDBN} is configured with @code{m68*-ericsson-*}, it will
10475instead have only a single special target command:
10476
10477@table @code
10478
10479@kindex target es1800
10480@item target es1800 @var{dev}
10481ES-1800 emulator for M68K.
10482
10483@end table
10484
10485[context?]
10486
10487@table @code
10488
10489@kindex target rombug
10490@item target rombug @var{dev}
10491ROMBUG ROM monitor for OS/9000.
10492
10493@end table
10494
10495@node M88K
10496@subsection M88K
10497
10498@table @code
10499
10500@kindex target bug
10501@item target bug @var{dev}
10502BUG monitor, running on a MVME187 (m88k) board.
10503
10504@end table
10505
10506@node MIPS Embedded
10507@subsection MIPS Embedded
10508
10509@cindex MIPS boards
10510@value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a
10511MIPS board attached to a serial line. This is available when
10512you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.
10513
10514@need 1000
10515Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
10516
10517@table @code
10518@item target mips @var{port}
10519@kindex target mips @var{port}
10520To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
10521name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
10522command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
10523the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
10524been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
10525download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
10526
10527For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
10528port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
10529debugger:
10530
10531@example
10532host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
2df3850c
JM
10533@value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
10534(@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
10535(@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
10536(@value{GDBP}) run
104c1213
JM
10537@end example
10538
10539@item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
10540On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
10541connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
10542concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
10543@samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
10544
10545@item target pmon @var{port}
10546@kindex target pmon @var{port}
10547PMON ROM monitor.
10548
10549@item target ddb @var{port}
10550@kindex target ddb @var{port}
10551NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
10552
10553@item target lsi @var{port}
10554@kindex target lsi @var{port}
10555LSI variant of PMON.
10556
10557@kindex target r3900
10558@item target r3900 @var{dev}
10559Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
10560
10561@kindex target array
10562@item target array @var{dev}
10563Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
10564
10565@end table
10566
10567
10568@noindent
10569@value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets:
10570
10571@table @code
10572@item set processor @var{args}
10573@itemx show processor
10574@kindex set processor @var{args}
10575@kindex show processor
10576Use the @code{set processor} command to set the type of MIPS
10577processor when you want to access processor-type-specific registers.
10578For example, @code{set processor @var{r3041}} tells @value{GDBN}
10579to use the CPO registers appropriate for the 3041 chip.
10580Use the @code{show processor} command to see what MIPS processor @value{GDBN}
10581is using. Use the @code{info reg} command to see what registers
10582@value{GDBN} is using.
10583
10584@item set mipsfpu double
10585@itemx set mipsfpu single
10586@itemx set mipsfpu none
10587@itemx show mipsfpu
10588@kindex set mipsfpu
10589@kindex show mipsfpu
10590@cindex MIPS remote floating point
10591@cindex floating point, MIPS remote
10592If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point
10593coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
10594need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBINIT}
10595file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
10596functions which return floating point values. It also allows
10597@value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
10598functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
10599with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
10600processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
10601double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
10602@samp{set mipsfpu double}.
10603
10604In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
10605floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
10606and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
10607
10608As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
10609@samp{show mipsfpu}.
10610
10611@item set remotedebug @var{n}
10612@itemx show remotedebug
d4f3574e
SS
10613@kindex set remotedebug@r{, MIPS protocol}
10614@kindex show remotedebug@r{, MIPS protocol}
104c1213
JM
10615@cindex @code{remotedebug}, MIPS protocol
10616@cindex MIPS @code{remotedebug} protocol
10617@c FIXME! For this to be useful, you must know something about the MIPS
10618@c FIXME...protocol. Where is it described?
10619You can see some debugging information about communications with the board
10620by setting the @code{remotedebug} variable. If you set it to @code{1} using
10621@samp{set remotedebug 1}, every packet is displayed. If you set it
10622to @code{2}, every character is displayed. You can check the current value
10623at any time with the command @samp{show remotedebug}.
10624
10625@item set timeout @var{seconds}
10626@itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
10627@itemx show timeout
10628@itemx show retransmit-timeout
10629@cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol
10630@cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol
10631@kindex set timeout
10632@kindex show timeout
10633@kindex set retransmit-timeout
10634@kindex show retransmit-timeout
10635You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS
10636remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
10637default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
10638waiting for an acknowledgement of a packet with the @code{set
10639retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
10640You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
10641retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
10642@value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.)
10643
10644The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
10645is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
10646forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
10647to run before stopping.
10648@end table
10649
10650@node PowerPC
10651@subsection PowerPC
10652
10653@table @code
10654
10655@kindex target dink32
10656@item target dink32 @var{dev}
10657DINK32 ROM monitor.
10658
10659@kindex target ppcbug
10660@item target ppcbug @var{dev}
10661@kindex target ppcbug1
10662@item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
10663PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
10664
10665@kindex target sds
10666@item target sds @var{dev}
10667SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
10668
10669@end table
10670
10671@node PA
10672@subsection HP PA Embedded
10673
10674@table @code
10675
10676@kindex target op50n
10677@item target op50n @var{dev}
10678OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
10679
10680@kindex target w89k
10681@item target w89k @var{dev}
10682W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
10683
10684@end table
10685
10686@node SH
10687@subsection Hitachi SH
10688
10689@table @code
10690
d4f3574e 10691@kindex target hms@r{, with Hitachi SH}
104c1213
JM
10692@item target hms @var{dev}
10693A Hitachi SH board attached via serial line to your host. Use special
10694commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial line and
10695the communications speed used.
10696
d4f3574e 10697@kindex target e7000@r{, with Hitachi SH}
104c1213
JM
10698@item target e7000 @var{dev}
10699E7000 emulator for Hitachi SH.
10700
d4f3574e
SS
10701@kindex target sh3@r{, with SH}
10702@kindex target sh3e@r{, with SH}
104c1213
JM
10703@item target sh3 @var{dev}
10704@item target sh3e @var{dev}
10705Hitachi SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
10706
10707@end table
10708
10709@node Sparclet
10710@subsection Tsqware Sparclet
10711
10712@cindex Sparclet
10713
10714@value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
10715Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
10716@value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
10717both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
d4f3574e 10718@code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
104c1213
JM
10719
10720@table @code
10721@item timeout @var{args}
10722@kindex remotetimeout
d4f3574e 10723@value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
104c1213
JM
10724This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
10725seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
10726@end table
10727
10728@kindex Compiling
d4f3574e
SS
10729When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
10730information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
10731load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
10732@samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
104c1213
JM
10733
10734@example
10735sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
10736@end example
10737
d4f3574e 10738You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
104c1213
JM
10739
10740@example
10741sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
10742@end example
10743
10744@kindex Running
10745Once you have set
10746your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
d4f3574e 10747run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
104c1213
JM
10748(or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
10749
10750@value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
10751
10752@example
10753(gdbslet)
10754@end example
10755
10756@menu
10757* Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
10758* Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
10759* Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
10760* Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
10761@end menu
10762
10763@node Sparclet File
10764@subsubsection Setting file to debug
10765
10766The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
10767
10768@example
10769(gdbslet) file prog
10770@end example
10771
10772@need 1000
10773@value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
10774@value{GDBN} locates
10775the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
10776path.
10777If the file was compiled with debug information (option "-g"), source
10778files will be searched as well.
10779@value{GDBN} locates
10780the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
10781path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}).
10782If it fails
10783to find a file, it displays a message such as:
10784
10785@example
10786prog: No such file or directory.
10787@end example
10788
10789When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
10790the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
10791@code{target} command again.
10792
10793@node Sparclet Connection
10794@subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
10795
10796The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
10797To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
10798
10799@example
10800(gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
10801Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
10802main () at ../prog.c:3
10803@end example
10804
10805@need 750
10806@value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
10807
d4f3574e 10808@example
104c1213 10809Connected to ttya.
d4f3574e 10810@end example
104c1213
JM
10811
10812@node Sparclet Download
10813@subsubsection Sparclet download
10814
10815@cindex download to Sparclet
10816Once connected to the Sparclet target,
10817you can use the @value{GDBN}
10818@code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
10819The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
10820command.
10821Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
d4f3574e 10822address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
104c1213
JM
10823offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
10824of each of the file's sections.
10825For instance, if the program
10826@file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
10827and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
10828
10829@example
10830(gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
10831Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
10832@end example
10833
10834If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
10835to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
10836to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
10837
10838@node Sparclet Execution
10839@subsubsection Running and debugging
10840
10841@cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
10842You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
10843commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
10844manual for the list of commands.
10845
10846@example
10847(gdbslet) b main
10848Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
10849(gdbslet) run
10850Starting program: prog
10851Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
108523 char *symarg = 0;
10853(gdbslet) step
108544 char *execarg = "hello!";
10855(gdbslet)
10856@end example
10857
10858@node Sparclite
10859@subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
10860
10861@table @code
10862
10863@kindex target sparclite
10864@item target sparclite @var{dev}
10865Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
10866You must use an additional command to debug the program.
10867For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
10868remote protocol.
10869
10870@end table
10871
10872@node ST2000
10873@subsection Tandem ST2000
10874
2df3850c 10875@value{GDBN} may be used with a Tandem ST2000 phone switch, running Tandem's
104c1213
JM
10876STDBUG protocol.
10877
10878To connect your ST2000 to the host system, see the manufacturer's
10879manual. Once the ST2000 is physically attached, you can run:
10880
10881@example
10882target st2000 @var{dev} @var{speed}
10883@end example
10884
10885@noindent
10886to establish it as your debugging environment. @var{dev} is normally
10887the name of a serial device, such as @file{/dev/ttya}, connected to the
10888ST2000 via a serial line. You can instead specify @var{dev} as a TCP
10889connection (for example, to a serial line attached via a terminal
10890concentrator) using the syntax @code{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
10891
10892The @code{load} and @code{attach} commands are @emph{not} defined for
10893this target; you must load your program into the ST2000 as you normally
10894would for standalone operation. @value{GDBN} reads debugging information
10895(such as symbols) from a separate, debugging version of the program
10896available on your host computer.
10897@c FIXME!! This is terribly vague; what little content is here is
10898@c basically hearsay.
10899
10900@cindex ST2000 auxiliary commands
10901These auxiliary @value{GDBN} commands are available to help you with the ST2000
10902environment:
10903
10904@table @code
10905@item st2000 @var{command}
10906@kindex st2000 @var{cmd}
10907@cindex STDBUG commands (ST2000)
10908@cindex commands to STDBUG (ST2000)
10909Send a @var{command} to the STDBUG monitor. See the manufacturer's
10910manual for available commands.
10911
10912@item connect
10913@cindex connect (to STDBUG)
10914Connect the controlling terminal to the STDBUG command monitor. When
10915you are done interacting with STDBUG, typing either of two character
10916sequences gets you back to the @value{GDBN} command prompt:
10917@kbd{@key{RET}~.} (Return, followed by tilde and period) or
10918@kbd{@key{RET}~@key{C-d}} (Return, followed by tilde and control-D).
10919@end table
10920
10921@node Z8000
10922@subsection Zilog Z8000
10923
10924@cindex Z8000
10925@cindex simulator, Z8000
10926@cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
10927
10928When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
10929a Z8000 simulator.
10930
10931For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
10932unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
10933segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
10934appropriate by inspecting the object code.
10935
10936@table @code
10937@item target sim @var{args}
10938@kindex sim
d4f3574e 10939@kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
104c1213
JM
10940Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
10941options, specify them via @var{args}.
10942@end table
10943
10944@noindent
10945After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
10946CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
10947@code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
10948to run your program, and so on.
10949
d4f3574e
SS
10950As well as making available all the usual machine registers
10951(@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
10952additional items of information as specially named registers:
104c1213
JM
10953
10954@table @code
10955
10956@item cycles
10957Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
10958
10959@item insts
10960Counts instructions run in the simulator.
10961
10962@item time
10963Execution time in 60ths of a second.
10964
10965@end table
10966
10967You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
10968conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
10969conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
10970simulated clock ticks.
10971
10972@node Architectures
10973@section Architectures
10974
10975This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
2df3850c 10976all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
104c1213
JM
10977
10978@menu
10979* A29K::
10980* Alpha::
10981* MIPS::
10982@end menu
10983
10984@node A29K
10985@subsection A29K
10986
10987@table @code
10988
10989@kindex set rstack_high_address
10990@cindex AMD 29K register stack
10991@cindex register stack, AMD29K
10992@item set rstack_high_address @var{address}
10993On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate
d4f3574e 10994@dfn{register stack}. There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the
104c1213
JM
10995extent of this stack. Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the
10996stack is ``large enough''. This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing
10997memory locations that do not exist. If necessary, you can get around
10998this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with
10999the @code{set rstack_high_address} command. The argument should be an
11000address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in
11001hexadecimal.
11002
11003@kindex show rstack_high_address
11004@item show rstack_high_address
11005Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family
11006processors.
11007
11008@end table
11009
11010@node Alpha
11011@subsection Alpha
11012
11013See the following section.
11014
11015@node MIPS
11016@subsection MIPS
11017
11018@cindex stack on Alpha
11019@cindex stack on MIPS
11020@cindex Alpha stack
11021@cindex MIPS stack
11022Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
11023sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
11024find the beginning of a function.
11025
11026@cindex response time, MIPS debugging
11027To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
11028@value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
11029you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
11030commands:
11031
11032@table @code
11033@cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha,MIPS)
11034@item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
11035Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
11036search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
11037default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
11038larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
11039and therefore the longer it takes to run.
11040
11041@item show heuristic-fence-post
11042Display the current limit.
11043@end table
11044
11045@noindent
11046These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
11047for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors.
11048
11049
c906108c
SS
11050@node Controlling GDB
11051@chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
11052
53a5351d
JM
11053You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
11054@code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
d4f3574e 11055data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}. Other settings are
53a5351d 11056described here.
c906108c
SS
11057
11058@menu
11059* Prompt:: Prompt
11060* Editing:: Command editing
11061* History:: Command history
11062* Screen Size:: Screen size
11063* Numbers:: Numbers
11064* Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
11065@end menu
11066
53a5351d 11067@node Prompt
c906108c
SS
11068@section Prompt
11069
11070@cindex prompt
11071
11072@value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
11073called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
11074can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
11075instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
11076the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
11077which one you are talking to.
11078
d4f3574e 11079@emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
c906108c
SS
11080prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
11081or a prompt that does not.
11082
11083@table @code
11084@kindex set prompt
11085@item set prompt @var{newprompt}
11086Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
11087
11088@kindex show prompt
11089@item show prompt
11090Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
11091@end table
11092
53a5351d 11093@node Editing
c906108c
SS
11094@section Command editing
11095@cindex readline
11096@cindex command line editing
11097
11098@value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{readline} interface. This
11099@sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
11100command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
11101or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
11102substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
11103debugging sessions.
11104
11105You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
11106command @code{set}.
11107
11108@table @code
11109@kindex set editing
11110@cindex editing
11111@item set editing
11112@itemx set editing on
11113Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
11114
11115@item set editing off
11116Disable command line editing.
11117
11118@kindex show editing
11119@item show editing
11120Show whether command line editing is enabled.
11121@end table
11122
53a5351d 11123@node History
c906108c
SS
11124@section Command history
11125
11126@value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
11127debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
11128happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
11129history facility.
11130
11131@table @code
11132@cindex history substitution
11133@cindex history file
11134@kindex set history filename
11135@kindex GDBHISTFILE
11136@item set history filename @var{fname}
11137Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
11138This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
11139list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
11140exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
11141the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
11142to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
d4f3574e
SS
11143@file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
11144is not set.
c906108c
SS
11145
11146@cindex history save
11147@kindex set history save
11148@item set history save
11149@itemx set history save on
11150Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
11151@code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
11152
11153@item set history save off
11154Stop recording command history in a file.
11155
11156@cindex history size
11157@kindex set history size
11158@item set history size @var{size}
11159Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
11160This defaults to the value of the environment variable
11161@code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
11162@end table
11163
11164@cindex history expansion
11165History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
11166@ifset have-readline-appendices
11167@xref{Event Designators}.
11168@end ifset
11169
11170Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
11171is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
11172@code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
11173follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
11174a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
11175history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
11176@kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
11177
11178The commands to control history expansion are:
11179
11180@table @code
11181@kindex set history expansion
11182@item set history expansion on
11183@itemx set history expansion
11184Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
11185
11186@item set history expansion off
11187Disable history expansion.
11188
11189The readline code comes with more complete documentation of
11190editing and history expansion features. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs
11191or @code{vi} may wish to read it.
11192@ifset have-readline-appendices
11193@xref{Command Line Editing}.
11194@end ifset
11195
11196@c @group
11197@kindex show history
11198@item show history
11199@itemx show history filename
11200@itemx show history save
11201@itemx show history size
11202@itemx show history expansion
11203These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
11204@code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
11205@c @end group
11206@end table
11207
11208@table @code
11209@kindex show commands
11210@item show commands
11211Display the last ten commands in the command history.
11212
11213@item show commands @var{n}
11214Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
11215
11216@item show commands +
11217Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
11218@end table
11219
53a5351d 11220@node Screen Size
c906108c
SS
11221@section Screen size
11222@cindex size of screen
11223@cindex pauses in output
11224
11225Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
11226information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
11227@value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
11228output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
11229to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
11230determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
11231printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
11232rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
11233
d4f3574e
SS
11234Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
11235driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
c906108c 11236together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
d4f3574e 11237@code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
c906108c
SS
11238you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
11239width} commands:
11240
11241@table @code
11242@kindex set height
11243@kindex set width
11244@kindex show width
11245@kindex show height
11246@item set height @var{lpp}
11247@itemx show height
11248@itemx set width @var{cpl}
11249@itemx show width
11250These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
11251a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
11252commands display the current settings.
11253
11254If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
11255output no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a
11256file or to an editor buffer.
11257
11258Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
11259from wrapping its output.
11260@end table
11261
53a5351d 11262@node Numbers
c906108c
SS
11263@section Numbers
11264@cindex number representation
11265@cindex entering numbers
11266
2df3850c
JM
11267You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
11268@value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
11269@samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
11270begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that begin with none of these are, by
11271default, entered in base 10; likewise, the default display for
11272numbers---when no particular format is specified---is base 10. You can
11273change the default base for both input and output with the @code{set
11274radix} command.
c906108c
SS
11275
11276@table @code
11277@kindex set input-radix
11278@item set input-radix @var{base}
11279Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
11280for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
11281specified either unambiguously or using the current default radix; for
11282example, any of
11283
11284@smallexample
11285set radix 012
11286set radix 10.
11287set radix 0xa
11288@end smallexample
11289
11290@noindent
11291sets the base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set radix 10}
11292leaves the radix unchanged no matter what it was.
11293
11294@kindex set output-radix
11295@item set output-radix @var{base}
11296Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
11297for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
11298specified either unambiguously or using the current default radix.
11299
11300@kindex show input-radix
11301@item show input-radix
11302Display the current default base for numeric input.
11303
11304@kindex show output-radix
11305@item show output-radix
11306Display the current default base for numeric display.
11307@end table
11308
53a5351d 11309@node Messages/Warnings
c906108c
SS
11310@section Optional warnings and messages
11311
2df3850c
JM
11312By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
11313running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
11314command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
11315internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
c906108c
SS
11316
11317Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
11318which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
11319see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}.
11320
11321@table @code
11322@kindex set verbose
11323@item set verbose on
11324Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
11325
11326@item set verbose off
11327Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
11328
11329@kindex show verbose
11330@item show verbose
11331Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
11332@end table
11333
2df3850c
JM
11334By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
11335object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
11336find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors reading
11337symbol files}).
c906108c
SS
11338
11339@table @code
2df3850c 11340
c906108c
SS
11341@kindex set complaints
11342@item set complaints @var{limit}
2df3850c
JM
11343Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
11344unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
11345@var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
11346to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
c906108c
SS
11347
11348@kindex show complaints
11349@item show complaints
11350Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
2df3850c 11351
c906108c
SS
11352@end table
11353
11354By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
11355lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
11356you try to run a program which is already running:
11357
11358@example
11359(@value{GDBP}) run
11360The program being debugged has been started already.
11361Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
11362@end example
11363
11364If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
11365commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
11366
11367@table @code
2df3850c 11368
c906108c
SS
11369@kindex set confirm
11370@cindex flinching
11371@cindex confirmation
11372@cindex stupid questions
11373@item set confirm off
11374Disables confirmation requests.
11375
11376@item set confirm on
11377Enables confirmation requests (the default).
11378
11379@kindex show confirm
11380@item show confirm
11381Displays state of confirmation requests.
2df3850c 11382
c906108c
SS
11383@end table
11384
53a5351d 11385@node Sequences
c906108c
SS
11386@chapter Canned Sequences of Commands
11387
11388Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
2df3850c
JM
11389command lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
11390commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
11391files.
c906108c
SS
11392
11393@menu
11394* Define:: User-defined commands
11395* Hooks:: User-defined command hooks
11396* Command Files:: Command files
11397* Output:: Commands for controlled output
11398@end menu
11399
53a5351d 11400@node Define
c906108c
SS
11401@section User-defined commands
11402
11403@cindex user-defined command
2df3850c
JM
11404A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
11405which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
11406@code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
11407separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
11408via @var{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
c906108c
SS
11409
11410@smallexample
11411define adder
11412 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
11413@end smallexample
11414
d4f3574e
SS
11415@noindent
11416To execute the command use:
c906108c
SS
11417
11418@smallexample
11419adder 1 2 3
11420@end smallexample
11421
d4f3574e
SS
11422@noindent
11423This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
c906108c
SS
11424its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
11425reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
11426functions calls.
11427
11428@table @code
2df3850c 11429
c906108c
SS
11430@kindex define
11431@item define @var{commandname}
11432Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
11433by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
11434
11435The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
11436which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
11437commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
11438
11439@kindex if
11440@kindex else
11441@item if
11442Takes a single argument, which is an expression to evaluate.
11443It is followed by a series of commands that are executed
11444only if the expression is true (nonzero).
11445There can then optionally be a line @code{else}, followed
11446by a series of commands that are only executed if the expression
11447was false. The end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
11448
11449@kindex while
11450@item while
11451The syntax is similar to @code{if}: the command takes a single argument,
11452which is an expression to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to
11453execute, one per line, terminated by an @code{end}.
11454The commands are executed repeatedly as long as the expression
11455evaluates to true.
11456
11457@kindex document
11458@item document @var{commandname}
11459Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
11460accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
11461defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
11462reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
11463After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
11464@var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
11465
11466You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
11467documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
11468does not change the documentation.
11469
11470@kindex help user-defined
11471@item help user-defined
11472List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation
11473(if any) for each.
11474
11475@kindex show user
11476@item show user
11477@itemx show user @var{commandname}
2df3850c
JM
11478Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
11479not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
c906108c 11480definitions for all user-defined commands.
2df3850c 11481
c906108c
SS
11482@end table
11483
11484When user-defined commands are executed, the
11485commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
11486stops execution of the user-defined command.
11487
11488If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
11489without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
11490commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
11491messages when used in a user-defined command.
11492
53a5351d 11493@node Hooks
c906108c 11494@section User-defined command hooks
d4f3574e
SS
11495@cindex command hooks
11496@cindex hooks, for commands
c906108c
SS
11497
11498You may define @emph{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
11499command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
11500command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
11501before that command.
11502
d4f3574e 11503@kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
c906108c
SS
11504In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
11505(@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
11506execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
11507displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
11508
c906108c
SS
11509For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
11510single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
11511you could define:
11512
11513@example
11514define hook-stop
11515handle SIGALRM nopass
11516end
11517
11518define hook-run
11519handle SIGALRM pass
11520end
11521
11522define hook-continue
11523handle SIGLARM pass
11524end
11525@end example
c906108c
SS
11526
11527You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
11528not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
11529name, e.g. @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
11530@c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
11531@c or not?
11532If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
11533@value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
11534(before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
11535
11536If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
11537get a warning from the @code{define} command.
11538
53a5351d 11539@node Command Files
c906108c
SS
11540@section Command files
11541
11542@cindex command files
11543A command file for @value{GDBN} is a file of lines that are @value{GDBN}
11544commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may also be included.
11545An empty line in a command file does nothing; it does not mean to repeat
11546the last command, as it would from the terminal.
11547
11548@cindex init file
11549@cindex @file{.gdbinit}
d4f3574e 11550@cindex @file{gdb.ini}
c906108c
SS
11551When you start @value{GDBN}, it automatically executes commands from its
11552@dfn{init files}. These are files named @file{.gdbinit} on Unix, or
11553@file{gdb.ini} on DOS/Windows. @value{GDBN} reads the init file (if
d4f3574e 11554any) in your home directory@footnote{On DOS/Windows systems, the home
2df3850c
JM
11555directory is the one pointed to by the @code{HOME} environment
11556variable.}, then processes command line options and operands, and then
11557reads the init file (if any) in the current working directory. This is
11558so the init file in your home directory can set options (such as
11559@code{set complaints}) which affect the processing of the command line
11560options and operands. The init files are not executed if you use the
11561@samp{-nx} option; @pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing modes}.
c906108c 11562
c906108c
SS
11563@cindex init file name
11564On some configurations of @value{GDBN}, the init file is known by a
11565different name (these are typically environments where a specialized
11566form of @value{GDBN} may need to coexist with other forms, hence a
11567different name for the specialized version's init file). These are the
11568environments with special init file names:
11569
11570@kindex .vxgdbinit
11571@itemize @bullet
11572@item
11573VxWorks (Wind River Systems real-time OS): @samp{.vxgdbinit}
11574
11575@kindex .os68gdbinit
11576@item
11577OS68K (Enea Data Systems real-time OS): @samp{.os68gdbinit}
11578
11579@kindex .esgdbinit
11580@item
11581ES-1800 (Ericsson Telecom AB M68000 emulator): @samp{.esgdbinit}
11582@end itemize
c906108c
SS
11583
11584You can also request the execution of a command file with the
11585@code{source} command:
11586
11587@table @code
11588@kindex source
11589@item source @var{filename}
11590Execute the command file @var{filename}.
11591@end table
11592
11593The lines in a command file are executed sequentially. They are not
11594printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates execution
11595of the command file.
11596
11597Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
11598without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
11599normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
11600when called from command files.
11601
53a5351d 11602@node Output
c906108c
SS
11603@section Commands for controlled output
11604
11605During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
11606@value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
11607explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
11608describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
11609want.
11610
11611@table @code
11612@kindex echo
11613@item echo @var{text}
11614@c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
11615@c because it is not in ANSI.
11616Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
11617@var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
11618newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
11619In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
11620by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
11621string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
11622trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
11623To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
11624@samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
11625
11626A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
11627the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
11628
11629@example
11630echo This is some text\n\
11631which is continued\n\
11632onto several lines.\n
11633@end example
11634
11635produces the same output as
11636
11637@example
11638echo This is some text\n
11639echo which is continued\n
11640echo onto several lines.\n
11641@end example
11642
11643@kindex output
11644@item output @var{expression}
11645Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
11646newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
11647value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
11648on expressions.
11649
11650@item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
11651Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
11652the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
11653formats}, for more information.
11654
11655@kindex printf
11656@item printf @var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
11657Print the values of the @var{expressions} under the control of
11658@var{string}. The @var{expressions} are separated by commas and may be
11659either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as specified by
11660@var{string}, exactly as if your program were to execute the C
11661subroutine
d4f3574e
SS
11662@c FIXME: the above implies that at least all ANSI C formats are
11663@c supported, but it isn't true: %E and %G don't work (or so it seems).
11664@c Either this is a bug, or the manual should document what formats are
11665@c supported.
c906108c
SS
11666
11667@example
11668printf (@var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
11669@end example
11670
11671For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
11672
11673@smallexample
11674printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
11675@end smallexample
11676
11677The only backslash-escape sequences that you can use in the format
11678string are the simple ones that consist of backslash followed by a
11679letter.
11680@end table
11681
53a5351d 11682@node Emacs
c906108c
SS
11683@chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
11684
11685@cindex Emacs
11686@cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
11687A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
11688edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
11689@value{GDBN}.
11690
11691To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
11692executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
11693@value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
11694created Emacs buffer.
53a5351d 11695@c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
c906108c
SS
11696
11697Using @value{GDBN} under Emacs is just like using @value{GDBN} normally except for two
11698things:
11699
11700@itemize @bullet
11701@item
11702All ``terminal'' input and output goes through the Emacs buffer.
11703@end itemize
11704
11705This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
11706and output done by the program you are debugging.
11707
11708This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
11709commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
11710in this way.
11711
11712All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
11713with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
11714way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
11715stop.
11716
11717@itemize @bullet
11718@item
11719@value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
11720@end itemize
11721
11722Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
11723source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
11724left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
11725source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
11726and the source.
11727
11728Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
11729usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
11730
11731@quotation
11732@emph{Warning:} If the directory where your program resides is not your
11733current directory, it can be easy to confuse Emacs about the location of
11734the source files, in which case the auxiliary display buffer does not
11735appear to show your source. @value{GDBN} can find programs by searching your
11736environment's @code{PATH} variable, so the @value{GDBN} input and output
11737session proceeds normally; but Emacs does not get enough information
11738back from @value{GDBN} to locate the source files in this situation. To
11739avoid this problem, either start @value{GDBN} mode from the directory where
11740your program resides, or specify an absolute file name when prompted for the
11741@kbd{M-x gdb} argument.
11742
11743A similar confusion can result if you use the @value{GDBN} @code{file} command to
11744switch to debugging a program in some other location, from an existing
11745@value{GDBN} buffer in Emacs.
11746@end quotation
11747
11748By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If
11749you need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you keep
11750several configurations around, with different names) you can set the
11751Emacs variable @code{gdb-command-name}; for example,
11752
11753@example
11754(setq gdb-command-name "mygdb")
11755@end example
11756
11757@noindent
d4f3574e 11758(preceded by @kbd{M-:} or @kbd{ESC :}, or typed in the @code{*scratch*} buffer, or
c906108c
SS
11759in your @file{.emacs} file) makes Emacs call the program named
11760``@code{mygdb}'' instead.
11761
11762In the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
11763addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
11764
11765@table @kbd
11766@item C-h m
11767Describe the features of Emacs' @value{GDBN} Mode.
11768
11769@item M-s
11770Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
11771update the display window to show the current file and location.
11772
11773@item M-n
11774Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
11775calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
11776to show the current file and location.
11777
11778@item M-i
11779Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
11780display window accordingly.
11781
11782@item M-x gdb-nexti
11783Execute to next instruction, using the @value{GDBN} @code{nexti} command; update
11784display window accordingly.
11785
11786@item C-c C-f
11787Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
11788@code{finish} command.
11789
11790@item M-c
11791Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
11792command.
11793
11794@emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-p}.
11795
11796@item M-u
11797Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
11798(@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
11799like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
11800
11801@emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-u}.
11802
11803@item M-d
11804Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
11805@value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
11806
11807@emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-d}.
11808
11809@item C-x &
11810Read the number where the cursor is positioned, and insert it at the end
11811of the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer. For example, if you wish to disassemble code
11812around an address that was displayed earlier, type @kbd{disassemble};
11813then move the cursor to the address display, and pick up the
11814argument for @code{disassemble} by typing @kbd{C-x &}.
11815
11816You can customize this further by defining elements of the list
11817@code{gdb-print-command}; once it is defined, you can format or
11818otherwise process numbers picked up by @kbd{C-x &} before they are
11819inserted. A numeric argument to @kbd{C-x &} indicates that you
11820wish special formatting, and also acts as an index to pick an element of the
11821list. If the list element is a string, the number to be inserted is
11822formatted using the Emacs function @code{format}; otherwise the number
11823is passed as an argument to the corresponding list element.
11824@end table
11825
11826In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x SPC} (@code{gdb-break})
11827tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
11828
11829If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
11830it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
11831request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
11832the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
11833frame.
11834
11835The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
11836which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
11837the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
11838communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
11839delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
11840to correspond properly with the code.
11841
11842@c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate
11843@c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
11844@ignore
11845@kindex Emacs Epoch environment
11846@kindex Epoch
11847@kindex inspect
11848
11849Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
11850called the @code{epoch}
11851environment. Users of this environment can use a new command,
11852@code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
11853each value is printed in its own window.
11854@end ignore
c906108c
SS
11855
11856@node GDB Bugs
c906108c
SS
11857@chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
11858@cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
11859@cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
11860
11861Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
11862
11863Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
11864may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
11865the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
11866reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
11867
11868In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
11869information that enables us to fix the bug.
11870
11871@menu
11872* Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
11873* Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
11874@end menu
11875
53a5351d 11876@node Bug Criteria
c906108c
SS
11877@section Have you found a bug?
11878@cindex bug criteria
11879
11880If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
11881
11882@itemize @bullet
11883@cindex fatal signal
11884@cindex debugger crash
11885@cindex crash of debugger
11886@item
11887If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
11888@value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
11889
11890@cindex error on valid input
11891@item
11892If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
11893bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
11894somewhere in the connection to the target.)
11895
11896@cindex invalid input
11897@item
11898If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
11899that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
11900``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
11901for traditional practice''.
11902
11903@item
11904If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
11905for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
11906@end itemize
11907
53a5351d 11908@node Bug Reporting
c906108c
SS
11909@section How to report bugs
11910@cindex bug reports
11911@cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
11912
c906108c
SS
11913A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
11914If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
11915contact that organization first.
11916
11917You can find contact information for many support companies and
11918individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
11919distribution.
11920@c should add a web page ref...
11921
11922In any event, we also recommend that you send bug reports for
11923@value{GDBN} to this addresses:
11924
11925@example
d4f3574e 11926bug-gdb@@gnu.org
c906108c
SS
11927@end example
11928
11929@strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
d4f3574e 11930@samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
c906108c
SS
11931not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
11932@samp{bug-gdb}.
11933
11934The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
11935serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
11936the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
11937newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
11938problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
11939path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
11940we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
11941bug reports to the mailing list.
11942
11943As a last resort, send bug reports on paper to:
11944
11945@example
11946@sc{gnu} Debugger Bugs
11947Free Software Foundation Inc.
1194859 Temple Place - Suite 330
11949Boston, MA 02111-1307
11950USA
11951@end example
c906108c
SS
11952
11953The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
11954@strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
11955fact or leave it out, state it!
11956
11957Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
11958problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
11959assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
11960Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
11961stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
11962name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
11963of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
11964the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
11965easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
11966
11967Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
11968bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
11969you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
11970self-contained.
11971
11972Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
11973bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
11974@emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
11975bugs properly.
11976
11977To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
11978
11979@itemize @bullet
11980@item
11981The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
11982with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
11983version}.
11984
11985Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
11986the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
11987
11988@item
11989The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
11990version number.
11991
c906108c
SS
11992@item
11993What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.
11994``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
c906108c
SS
11995
11996@item
11997What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
11998debugging---e.g. ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
11999C Compiler''. For GCC, you can say @code{gcc --version} to get this
12000information; for other compilers, see the documentation for those
12001compilers.
12002
12003@item
12004The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
12005observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
12006you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
12007Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
12008
12009If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
12010and then we might not encounter the bug.
12011
12012@item
12013A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
12014reproduce the bug.
12015
12016@item
12017A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
12018incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
12019
12020Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
12021will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
12022not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
12023a chance to make a mistake.
12024
12025Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
12026say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
12027copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
12028the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
12029crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
12030ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
12031us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
12032to draw any conclusion from our observations.
12033
c906108c
SS
12034@item
12035If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
12036diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
12037it by context, not by line number.
12038
12039The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
12040sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
53a5351d 12041
c906108c
SS
12042@end itemize
12043
12044Here are some things that are not necessary:
12045
12046@itemize @bullet
12047@item
12048A description of the envelope of the bug.
12049
12050Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
12051which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
12052changes will not affect it.
12053
12054This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
12055will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
12056with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
12057We recommend that you save your time for something else.
12058
12059Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
12060of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
12061output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
12062less time, and so on.
12063
12064However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
12065report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
12066
12067@item
12068A patch for the bug.
12069
12070A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
12071the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
12072a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
12073to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
12074
12075Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
12076construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
12077through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
12078to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
12079
12080And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
12081patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
12082help us to understand.
12083
12084@item
12085A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
12086
12087Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
12088things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
12089@end itemize
12090
12091@c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
12092@c and consists of the two following files:
12093@c rluser.texinfo
7be570e7 12094@c inc-hist.texinfo
c906108c
SS
12095@c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
12096@c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
12097@include rluser.texinfo
7be570e7 12098@include inc-hist.texinfo
c906108c
SS
12099
12100
c906108c 12101@node Formatting Documentation
c906108c
SS
12102@appendix Formatting Documentation
12103
12104@cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
12105@cindex reference card
12106The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
12107for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
12108subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
12109@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
12110release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
12111you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
12112
12113The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
12114can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
12115
12116@example
12117make refcard.dvi
12118@end example
12119
12120The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
12121mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
12122that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
12123high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
12124your @sc{dvi} output program.
12125
12126@cindex documentation
12127
12128All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
12129distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
12130a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
12131on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
12132formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
12133and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
12134
12135@value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
12136version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
12137file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
12138subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
12139necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
12140but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
12141Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
12142@sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
12143
12144If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
12145Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
12146@code{makeinfo}.
12147
12148If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
12149@value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
12150version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
12151
12152@example
12153cd gdb
12154make gdb.info
12155@end example
12156
12157If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
12158a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
12159Texinfo definitions file.
12160
12161@TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
12162produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
12163document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
12164has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
12165command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
12166(for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
12167require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
12168
12169@TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
12170@file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
12171written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
12172typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
12173and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
12174directory.
12175
12176If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
12177typeset and print this manual. First switch to the the @file{gdb}
12178subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
12179@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
12180
12181@example
12182make gdb.dvi
12183@end example
12184
12185Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
c906108c 12186
53a5351d 12187@node Installing GDB
c906108c
SS
12188@appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
12189@cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
12190@cindex installation
12191
c906108c
SS
12192@value{GDBN} comes with a @code{configure} script that automates the process
12193of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
12194build the @code{gdb} program.
12195@iftex
12196@c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
12197@footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
12198look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
12199installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
12200@end iftex
12201
12202The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
12203@value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
12204appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
12205
12206For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
12207@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
12208
12209@table @code
12210@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
12211script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
12212
12213@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
12214the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
12215
12216@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
12217source for the Binary File Descriptor library
12218
12219@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
12220@sc{gnu} include files
12221
12222@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
12223source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
12224
12225@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
12226source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
12227
12228@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
12229source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
12230
12231@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
12232source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
12233
12234@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
12235source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
12236@end table
12237
12238The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @code{configure}
12239from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
12240this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
12241
12242First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
12243if you are not already in it; then run @code{configure}. Pass the
12244identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
12245argument.
12246
12247For example:
12248
12249@example
12250cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
12251./configure @var{host}
12252make
12253@end example
12254
12255@noindent
12256where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
12257@samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
12258(You can often leave off @var{host}; @code{configure} tries to guess the
12259correct value by examining your system.)
12260
12261Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
12262@file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
12263libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
12264binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
12265
12266@need 750
12267@code{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
12268system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
12269shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
12270
12271@example
12272sh configure @var{host}
12273@end example
12274
12275If you run @code{configure} from a directory that contains source
12276directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
12277@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN}, @code{configure}
12278creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
12279you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
12280
12281You can run the @code{configure} script from any of the
12282subordinate directories in the @value{GDBN} distribution if you only want to
12283configure that subdirectory, but be sure to specify a path to it.
12284
12285For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, type the following to configure only
12286the @code{bfd} subdirectory:
12287
12288@example
12289@group
12290cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
12291../configure @var{host}
12292@end group
12293@end example
12294
12295You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
12296However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
12297the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
12298that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
12299let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
12300
12301@menu
12302* Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
12303* Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
12304* Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
12305@end menu
12306
53a5351d 12307@node Separate Objdir
c906108c
SS
12308@section Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
12309
12310If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
12311you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
12312host and target. @code{configure} is designed to make this easy by
12313allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
12314rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
12315handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
12316@code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
12317program specified there.
12318
12319To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @code{configure}
12320with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
12321(You also need to specify a path to find @code{configure}
12322itself from your working directory. If the path to @code{configure}
12323would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
12324the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
12325
12326For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
12327separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
12328
12329@example
12330@group
12331cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
12332mkdir ../gdb-sun4
12333cd ../gdb-sun4
12334../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
12335make
12336@end group
12337@end example
12338
12339When @code{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
12340directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
12341(and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
12342the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
12343directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
12344@file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
12345
12346One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
12347directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
12348@value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
12349programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
12350You specify a cross-debugging target by
12351giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @code{configure}.
12352
12353When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
12354it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
12355called @code{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
12356
12357The @code{Makefile} that @code{configure} generates in each source
12358directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
12359directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
12360directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
12361will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
12362
12363When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
12364directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
12365if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
12366with each other.
12367
53a5351d 12368@node Config Names
c906108c
SS
12369@section Specifying names for hosts and targets
12370
12371The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @code{configure}
12372script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
12373aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
12374of information in the following pattern:
12375
12376@example
12377@var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
12378@end example
12379
12380For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
12381or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
12382option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
12383
12384The @code{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
12385any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
12386aliases. @code{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
12387@code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
12388script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
12389abbreviations---for example:
12390
12391@smallexample
12392% sh config.sub i386-linux
12393i386-pc-linux-gnu
12394% sh config.sub alpha-linux
12395alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
12396% sh config.sub hp9k700
12397hppa1.1-hp-hpux
12398% sh config.sub sun4
12399sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
12400% sh config.sub sun3
12401m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
12402% sh config.sub i986v
12403Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
12404@end smallexample
12405
12406@noindent
12407@code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
12408directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
12409
53a5351d 12410@node Configure Options
c906108c
SS
12411@section @code{configure} options
12412
12413Here is a summary of the @code{configure} options and arguments that
12414are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @code{configure} also has
12415several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
12416Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @code{configure}.
12417
12418@example
12419configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
12420 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
12421 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
12422 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
12423 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
12424 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
12425 @var{host}
12426@end example
12427
12428@noindent
12429You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
12430@samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
12431@samp{--}.
12432
12433@table @code
12434@item --help
12435Display a quick summary of how to invoke @code{configure}.
12436
12437@item --prefix=@var{dir}
12438Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
12439@file{@var{dir}}.
12440
12441@item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
12442Configure the source to install programs under directory
12443@file{@var{dir}}.
12444
12445@c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
12446@need 2000
12447@item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
12448@strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
12449@code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
12450Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
12451@value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
12452build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
12453directories. @code{configure} writes configuration specific files in
12454the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
12455directory @var{dirname}. @code{configure} creates directories under
12456the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
12457@var{dirname}.
12458
12459@item --norecursion
12460Configure only the directory level where @code{configure} is executed; do not
12461propagate configuration to subdirectories.
12462
12463@item --target=@var{target}
12464Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
12465@var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
12466programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
12467
12468There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
12469
12470@item @var{host} @dots{}
12471Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
12472
12473There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
12474@end table
12475
12476There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
12477needed for special purposes only.
c906108c 12478
53a5351d 12479@node Index
c906108c
SS
12480@unnumbered Index
12481
12482@printindex cp
12483
12484@tex
12485% I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo. In the
12486% meantime:
12487\long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
12488\centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
12489\centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
12490\centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
12491\centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
12492\centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
12493\centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
12494\centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
12495\centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
12496\page\colophon
12497% Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991.
12498@end tex
12499
12500@contents
12501@bye
This page took 0.794193 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.